]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
ishft_3.f90: Update test.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050 1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
58cd1d70 2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
38f8b050
JR
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
acce4e77
JM
94Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
dd5a833e 97initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
acce4e77
JM
98@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
c49a6962
JM
102Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
105@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107@file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
108@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110default definition is used.
111
38f8b050
JR
112@node Driver
113@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114@cindex driver
115@cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117@c prevent bad page break with this line
118You can control the compilation driver.
119
38f8b050
JR
120@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
122initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
127applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
129using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136@end defmac
137
138@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
141for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
145the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
146to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
147@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148everywhere it occurs.
149
150The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155@end defmac
156
157@defmac CPP_SPEC
158A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
160give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163@end defmac
164
165@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169@end defmac
170
171@defmac CC1_SPEC
172A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174front ends.
175It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179@end defmac
180
181@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
184give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190@end defmac
191
192@defmac ASM_SPEC
193A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
195you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199@end defmac
200
201@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
205an example of this.
206
207Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208@end defmac
209
210@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
215@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
219cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221@end defmac
222
223@defmac LINK_SPEC
224A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
226give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229@end defmac
230
231@defmac LIB_SPEC
232Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
233between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234command given to the linker.
235
236If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
238@end defmac
239
240@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
244the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248@end defmac
249
250@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
256targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260@end defmac
261
262@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
265generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268@end defmac
269
270@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275@end defmac
276
277@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
279difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
284@end defmac
285
286@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
288difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292@end defmac
293
294@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
298@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
300default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302@end defmac
303
304@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308@end defmac
309
310@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
313updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315@end defmac
316
317@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320@code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324string constant that provides the specification.
325
326Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331these definitions.
332
333For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336used.
337
338The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340@smallexample
341#define EXTRA_SPECS \
342 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345@end smallexample
346
347The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348@smallexample
349#undef CPP_SPEC
350#define CPP_SPEC \
351"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358@end smallexample
359
360while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363@smallexample
364#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366@end smallexample
367@end defmac
368
369@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373@end defmac
374
375@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378@end defmac
379
380@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
384define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388@end defmac
389
390@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
391A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
392directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
393removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
394@end defmac
395
c49a6962
JM
396@hook TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
397
38f8b050
JR
398@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
399Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
400string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
401target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
402@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
403
404Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
405the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
406@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
407@xref{Target Fragment}.
408@end defmac
409
410@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
411Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
412a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
413indicates an absolute file name.
414@end defmac
415
416@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
417If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
418@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
419when the compiler is built as a cross
420compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
421to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
422@end defmac
423
424@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
425Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
426standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
427try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
428@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
429is built as a cross compiler.
430@end defmac
431
432@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
433Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
434standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
435when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
436@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
437is built as a cross compiler.
438@end defmac
439
440@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
441Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
442standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
443default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
444@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
445is built as a cross compiler.
446@end defmac
447
448@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
449If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
450standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
451compiler is built as a cross compiler.
452@end defmac
453
454@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
455If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
456standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
457cross compiler.
458@end defmac
459
460@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
461Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
462variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
463loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
464initialize the necessary environment variables.
465@end defmac
466
467@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
468Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
469standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
470try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
08b2bad2
SB
471comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
472@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
38f8b050
JR
473
474Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
475replacement.
476@end defmac
477
08b2bad2
SB
478@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
479The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
38f8b050
JR
480See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
481If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
482@end defmac
483
484@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
485Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
486for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
487usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
08b2bad2
SB
488@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
489@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
38f8b050
JR
490and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
491and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
492@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
493
494The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
495Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
496string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
497for C++-only directories,
498and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
499wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
500the array with a null element.
501
502The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
503if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
504or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
505operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
506
507For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
508
509@smallexample
510#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
511@{ \
512 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
513 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
515 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
516 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
517@}
518@end smallexample
519@end defmac
520
521Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
522
523@enumerate
524@item
525Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
526
527@item
528The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
ff2ce160 529is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
38f8b050
JR
530@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
531
532@item
533The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
534
535@item
536The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
ff2ce160 537in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
38f8b050
JR
538
539@item
ff2ce160 540The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
541
542@item
ff2ce160 543The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
544
545@item
ff2ce160 546The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
38f8b050
JR
547compiler.
548@end enumerate
549
550Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
551
552@enumerate
553@item
554Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
555
556@item
557The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
558value based on the installed toolchain location.
559
560@item
561The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
562(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
563
564@item
565The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
ff2ce160 566in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
567
568@item
569The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
570
571@item
ff2ce160 572The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
38f8b050
JR
573compiler.
574
575@item
ff2ce160 576The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
38f8b050
JR
577native compiler, or we have a target system root.
578
579@item
ff2ce160 580The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
38f8b050
JR
581native compiler, or we have a target system root.
582
583@item
584The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
585If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
586the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
587
588@item
589The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
590compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
591@file{/lib/}.
592
593@item
594The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
595compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
596@file{/usr/lib/}.
597@end enumerate
598
599@node Run-time Target
600@section Run-time Target Specification
601@cindex run-time target specification
602@cindex predefined macros
603@cindex target specifications
604
605@c prevent bad page break with this line
606Here are run-time target specifications.
607
608@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
609This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
610built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
611the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
612@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
613calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
614finished command line option processing your code can use those
615results freely.
616
617@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
618command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
619the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
620accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
621
622@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
623object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
624@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
625defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
626with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
627only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
628example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
629and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
630@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
631defines only @code{_ABI64}.
632
633You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
634@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
635or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
636assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
637macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
638to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
639variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
640@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
641preprocessing.
642@end defmac
643
644@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
645Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
646and is used for the target operating system instead.
647@end defmac
648
649@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
650Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
651and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
652macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
653it yourself.
654@end defmac
655
656@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
657This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
658any target-specific headers.
659@end deftypevar
660
661@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
662This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
663Its default setting is 0.
664@end deftypevr
665
666@cindex optional hardware or system features
667@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
668
669@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
670This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
671target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
672(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
673processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
674definition does nothing but return true.
675
96e45421
JM
676@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
677@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
678storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
679option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
680via attributes).
38f8b050
JR
681@end deftypefn
682
683@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
684This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
685target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
686definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
687option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
688valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
689default definition does nothing but return false.
690
691In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
692options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
693only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
694should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
695@end deftypefn
696
91ebb981
IS
697@hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
698
699@hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
700
701@hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
26705988 702
38f8b050
JR
703@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
704This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
705but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
706pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
707attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
708when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
709actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
710@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
711@end deftypefn
712
713@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
714This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
715but is only used in the C
38f8b050
JR
716language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
717used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
718frontends.
719@end defmac
720
3020190e 721@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
38f8b050 722Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
723various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
724options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
725options are processed once
38f8b050 726just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e 727of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
2b0d3573 728options passed explicitly.
38f8b050 729
3020190e 730This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
38f8b050
JR
731options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
732@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 733@end deftypevr
38f8b050 734
7e4aae92
JM
735@hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
736
128dc8e2
JM
737@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
738
3bd36029
RS
739@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
740Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
741during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
742the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
743can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
744and @code{nomips16} attributes.
745
746Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
747registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
748operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
749in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
750significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
751for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
752switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
753
754Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
755is 0.
756@end defmac
757
38f8b050
JR
758@node Per-Function Data
759@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
760@cindex per-function data
761@cindex data structures
762
763If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
764provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
765using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
766nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
767when another one comes along.
768
769GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
770contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
771structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
772@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
773to their own specific data.
774
775If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
776@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
777This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
778@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
779
780One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
781RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
782RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
783function, for level 0.
784
785Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
786all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
787function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
788stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
789stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
790@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
791the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
792single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
793longer supported.
794
795@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
796Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
797is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
798The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
799function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
800@end defmac
801
802@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
803If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
804function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
805target to perform any target specific initialization of the
806@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
807used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
808
809@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
810Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
811GC allocation, including the structure itself.
812@end deftypevar
813
814@node Storage Layout
815@section Storage Layout
816@cindex storage layout
817
818Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
819alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
820expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
821@xref{Run-time Target}.
822
823@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
824Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
825byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
826This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
827bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
828be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
829macro need not be a constant.
830
831This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
832bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
833@end defmac
834
835@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
836Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
837word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
838@end defmac
839
840@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
841Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
842most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
c0a6a1ef
BS
843memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
844order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
38f8b050
JR
845macro need not be a constant.
846@end defmac
847
c0a6a1ef
BS
848@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
849On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
850registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
851the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
852the order of words in memory.
853@end defmac
854
38f8b050
JR
855@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
856Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
857@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
858containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
859have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
860
861You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
862multi-word integers.
863@end defmac
864
865@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
866Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
867unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
868@end defmac
869
870@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
871Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
872is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
873@end defmac
874
875@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
876Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
877@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
878largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
879@end defmac
880
881@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
882Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
883register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
884@end defmac
885
886@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
887Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
888@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
889smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
890@end defmac
891
38f8b050
JR
892@defmac POINTER_SIZE
893Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
894width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
895you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
896a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
897@end defmac
898
899@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
900A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
901@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
902greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
903should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
904is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
905@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
906
907You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
908and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
909@end defmac
910
911@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
912A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
913is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
914stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
915scalar type.
916
917On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
918register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
919@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
920cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
921floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
922counterparts.
923
924For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
925However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
926either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
927the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
928sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
929@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
930
931Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
932@end defmac
933
934@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
935Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
936function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
937and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
938change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
939pointer} types.
940
941@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
942return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
943@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
944If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
945which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
946then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
947the signedness may be different.
948
5e617be8
AK
949@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
950
38f8b050
JR
951The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
952also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
953if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
954@end deftypefn
955
956@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
957Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
958bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
959regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
960size of an integer.
961@end defmac
962
963@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
964Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
965stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
966desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
967if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
968this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
969@end defmac
970
971@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
972Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
973stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
974is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
975macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
976@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
977@end defmac
978
979@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
980Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
981from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
982to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
983@end defmac
984
985@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
986Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
987@end defmac
988
989@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
990Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
991bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
992just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
993@end defmac
994
995@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
996Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
997provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
998@end defmac
999
1000@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1001Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1002not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1003@end defmac
1004
1005@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1006If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1007object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1008nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1009on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1010@end defmac
1011
1012@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1013Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1014machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1015structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1016by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1017@end defmac
1018
1019@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1020An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1021alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1022@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1023alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1024field alignment has not been set by the
1025@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1026@end defmac
1027
1028@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1029Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1030to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1031
1032If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1033
1034@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1035@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1036@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1037@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1038@end defmac
1039
1040@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1041Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1042Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1043@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1044the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1045
1046On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1047the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1048a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1049On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1050@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1051@end defmac
1052
1053@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1054If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1055the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1056the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1057macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1058
1059If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1060
1061@findex strcpy
1062One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1063make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1064arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1065constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1066@end defmac
1067
1068@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1069If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1070that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1071@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1072have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1073align the object.
1074
1075If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1076
1077The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1078constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1079constants can be done inline.
1080@end defmac
1081
1082@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1083If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1084the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1085the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1086macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1087
1088If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1089
1090One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1091make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1092
64ad7c99 1093If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1094@end defmac
1095
1096@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1097If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1098@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1099and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1100have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1101align the slot.
1102
1103If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1104@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1105be used.
1106
1107This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1108of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad 1109
64ad7c99 1110If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1111@end defmac
1112
1113@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1114If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1115variable @var{decl}.
1116
1117If this macro is not defined, then
1118@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1119is used.
1120
1121One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1122make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1123
64ad7c99 1124If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1125@end defmac
1126
1127@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1128If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1129for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1130@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1131
1132If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1133@end defmac
1134
1135@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1136Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1137empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1138
1139If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1140@end defmac
1141
1142@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1143Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1144Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1145
1146If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1147@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1148@end defmac
1149
1150@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1151Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1152if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1153go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1154@end defmac
1155
1156@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1157Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1158alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1159
1160The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1161@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1162structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1163that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1164that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1165
1166Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1167@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1168four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1169not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1170
1171An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1172structure.
1173
1174If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1175a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1176
1177Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1178bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1179support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1180@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1181
1182The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1183@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1184Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1185
1186Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1187@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1188@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1189
1190If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1191bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1192what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1193
1194@smallexample
1195struct foo1
1196@{
1197 char x;
1198 char :0;
1199 char y;
1200@};
1201
1202struct foo2
1203@{
1204 char x;
1205 int :0;
1206 char y;
1207@};
1208
1209main ()
1210@{
1211 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1212 sizeof (struct foo1));
1213 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1214 sizeof (struct foo2));
1215 exit (0);
1216@}
1217@end smallexample
1218
1219If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1220get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1221@end defmac
1222
1223@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1224Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1225to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1226@end defmac
1227
1228@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1229When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1230whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1231structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1232the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1233@end deftypefn
1234
1235@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1236This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1237should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1238these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1239
1240The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1241@end deftypefn
1242
1243@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1244Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1245@code{BLKMODE}.
1246
1247If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1248mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1249case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1250retain the field's mode.
1251
1252Normally, this is not needed.
1253@end defmac
1254
1255@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1256Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1257by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1258way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1259@var{specified}.
1260
1261The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1262the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1263@end defmac
1264
1265@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1266An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1267machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1268this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1269appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1270(DImode)} is assumed.
1271@end defmac
1272
1273@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1274If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1275specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1276@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1277@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1278@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1279having its mode specified.
1280
1281You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1282would most commonly define this macro if the
1283@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
128464-bit mode.
1285@end defmac
1286
1287@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1288If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1289specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1290@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1291
1292You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1293You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1294pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1295@end defmac
1296
1297@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1298This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1299of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1300@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1301targets.
1302@end deftypefn
1303
1304@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1305This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1306of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1307@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1308targets.
1309@end deftypefn
1310
1311@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1312Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1313The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1314@end deftypefn
1315
1316@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1317If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1318mode is towards zero.
1319
1320Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1321floating-point arithmetic.
1322
1323Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1324@end defmac
1325
1326@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1327This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1328bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1329exponent for normal numbers instead.
1330
1331Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1332floating-point arithmetic.
1333
1334The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1335@end defmac
1336
1337@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1338This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1339@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1340Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1341unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1342different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1343alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1344bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1345the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1346(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1347another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1348other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1349
1350When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1351of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1352bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1353and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1354chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1355size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1356alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1357
1358If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1359the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1360used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1361precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1362may affect its placement.
1363@end deftypefn
1364
1365@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1366Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1367@end deftypefn
1368
1369@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1370Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1371@end deftypefn
1372
1373@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1374This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1375to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1376For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1377for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1378registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1379usage.
1380@end deftypefn
1381
1382@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1383This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1384that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1385@end deftypefn
1386
1387@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1388If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1389uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1390to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1391mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1392the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1393not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1394for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1395return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1396string constant.
1397
1398Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1399qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1400fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1401is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1402length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1403ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1404@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1405@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1406code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1407@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1408codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1409spaces in your string.
1410
1411This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1412name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1413can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1414before mangling.
1415
1416The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1417appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1418types.
1419@end deftypefn
1420
1421@node Type Layout
1422@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1423
1424These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1425basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1426the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1427languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1428
1429@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1430A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1431target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1432@end defmac
1433
1434@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1435A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1436target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1437(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1438unit.)
1439@end defmac
1440
1441@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1442A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1443target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1444@end defmac
1445
1446@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1447On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1448@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1449that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1450the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1451value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1452@end defmac
1453
1454@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1455A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1456target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1457words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1458macro must be at least 64.
1459@end defmac
1460
1461@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1462A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1463target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1464@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1465@end defmac
1466
1467@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1468A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1469C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1470this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1471@end defmac
1472
1473@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1474A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1475target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1476@end defmac
1477
1478@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1479A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1480target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1481words.
1482@end defmac
1483
1484@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1485A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1486the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1487words.
1488@end defmac
1489
1490@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1491A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1492the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1493@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1494@end defmac
1495
1496@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1497A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1498the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1499@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1500@end defmac
1501
1502@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1503A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1504the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1505@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1506@end defmac
1507
1508@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1509A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1510the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1511@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1512@end defmac
1513
1514@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1515A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1516the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1517@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1518@end defmac
1519
1520@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1521A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1522the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1524@end defmac
1525
1526@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1527A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1528the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1530@end defmac
1531
1532@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1533A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1534the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1536@end defmac
1537
1538@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1539Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1540if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1541@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1542default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1543@end defmac
1544
1545@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1546Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
38f8b050
JR
1547@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1548@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1549anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
38f8b050
JR
1550or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1551otherwise it is 0.
1552@end defmac
1553
1554@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1555Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1556@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1557anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1558is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1559@end defmac
1560
1561@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1562Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1563@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1564anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1565is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1566@end defmac
1567
cdbf4541
BS
1568@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1569This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1570hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1571causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1572prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1573uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1574the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1575@end defmac
1576
38f8b050
JR
1577@defmac SF_SIZE
1578@defmacx DF_SIZE
1579@defmacx XF_SIZE
1580@defmacx TF_SIZE
1581Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1582@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1583if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1584@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1585for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1586@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1587@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
38f8b050
JR
1588@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1589@end defmac
1590
1591@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1592A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1593assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1594default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1595@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1596@end defmac
1597
1598@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1599A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1600supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1601value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1602If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1603is the default.
1604@end defmac
1605
1606@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1607An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1608@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1609always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1610and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1611@end defmac
1612
1613@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1614This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1615@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1616of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1617@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1618
1619The default is to return false.
1620@end deftypefn
1621
1622@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1623A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1624for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1625contents of the string.
1626
1627The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1628spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1629appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1630of the data type names defined in the function
1631@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1632omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1633crash on startup.
1634
1635If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1636int"}.
1637@end defmac
1638
1639@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1640A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1641for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1642@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1643@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1644
1645If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1646@end defmac
1647
1648@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1649A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1650for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1651the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1652information.
1653
1654If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1655@end defmac
1656
1657@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1658A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1659characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1660@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1661@end defmac
1662
1663@defmac WINT_TYPE
1664A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1665use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1666@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1667contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1668information.
1669
1670If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1671@end defmac
1672
1673@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1674A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1675can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1676The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1677string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1678
1679If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1680@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1681much precision as @code{long long int}.
1682@end defmac
1683
1684@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1685A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1686can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1687type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1688of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1689
1690If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1691@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1692unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1693int}.
1694@end defmac
1695
1696@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1697@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1698@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1699@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1700@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1701@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1702@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1703@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1704@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1705@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1706@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1707@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1708@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1709@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1710@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1711@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1712@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1713@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1714@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1715@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1716@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1717@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1718@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1719@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1720@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1721@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1722@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1723C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1724@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1725@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1726@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1727@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1728@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1729@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1730@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1731@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1732@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1733
1734If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1735type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1736@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1737to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1738these macros are null pointers.
1739@end defmac
1740
1741@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1742The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1743that looks like:
1744
1745@smallexample
1746 struct @{
1747 union @{
1748 void (*fn)();
1749 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1750 @};
1751 ptrdiff_t delta;
1752 @};
1753@end smallexample
1754
1755@noindent
1756The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1757will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1758Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1759always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1760distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1761platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1762that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1763the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1764
1765GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1766this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1767However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1768set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1769bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1770address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1771architecture, you should define this macro to
1772@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1773
1774In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1775in which function addresses are always even, according to
1776@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1777@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1778@end defmac
1779
1780@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1781Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1782macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1783instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1784function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1785data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1786pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1787
1788If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1789of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1790@end defmac
1791
1792@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1793By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1794is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1795the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1796when special alignment is necessary. */
1797@end defmac
1798
1799@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1800There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1801zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1802specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1803of words in each data entry.
1804@end defmac
1805
1806@node Registers
1807@section Register Usage
1808@cindex register usage
1809
1810This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1811has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1812
1813The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1814done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1815on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1816For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1817For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1818
1819@menu
1820* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1821* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1822* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1823* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1824* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1825@end menu
1826
1827@node Register Basics
1828@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1829
1830@c prevent bad page break with this line
1831Registers have various characteristics.
1832
1833@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1834Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1835numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1836pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1837@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1838@end defmac
1839
1840@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1841@cindex fixed register
1842An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1843all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1844general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1845pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1846register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1847machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1848and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1849
1850This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1851commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1852register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1853
1854The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1855the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1856by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1857the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1858@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1859@end defmac
1860
1861@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1862@cindex call-used register
1863@cindex call-clobbered register
1864@cindex call-saved register
1865Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1866clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1867registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1868available for general allocation of values that must live across
1869function calls.
1870
1871If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1872automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1873exit, if the register is used within the function.
1874@end defmac
1875
1876@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1877@cindex call-used register
1878@cindex call-clobbered register
1879@cindex call-saved register
1880Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1881that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1882(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1883This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1884of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1885@end defmac
1886
1887@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1888@cindex call-used register
1889@cindex call-clobbered register
1890@cindex call-saved register
1891A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1892value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1893call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1894macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1895preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1896@end defmac
1897
1898@findex fixed_regs
1899@findex call_used_regs
1900@findex global_regs
1901@findex reg_names
1902@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1903@hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1904This hook may conditionally modify five variables
38f8b050
JR
1905@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1906@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1907any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1908of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1909@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1910@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1911called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1912@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1913from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1914@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1915@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1916@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1917command options have been applied.
1918
38f8b050
JR
1919@cindex disabling certain registers
1920@cindex controlling register usage
1921If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1922flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1923@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1924registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1925the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1926to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1927is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1928
1929(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1930of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1931controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1932these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1933@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
1934
1935@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1936Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1937expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1938corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1939function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1940outbound register.
1941@end defmac
1942
1943@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1944Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1945expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1946corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1947function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1948register.
1949@end defmac
1950
1951@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1952Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1953expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1954register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1955need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1956gotos.
1957@end defmac
1958
1959@defmac PC_REGNUM
1960If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1961register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1962@end defmac
1963
1964@node Allocation Order
1965@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1966@cindex order of register allocation
1967@cindex register allocation order
1968
1969@c prevent bad page break with this line
1970Registers are allocated in order.
1971
1972@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1973If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1974numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1975to use them (from most preferred to least).
1976
1977If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1978(all else being equal).
1979
1980One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1981registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1982instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1983machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1984the highest numbered allocable register first.
1985@end defmac
1986
1987@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1988A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1989hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1990
1991Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1992Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1993register; and so on.
1994
1995The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1996@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1997
1998On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1999@end defmac
2000
2001@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2002Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2003prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2004using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2005allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2006call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2007should be defined.
2008@end defmac
2009
2010@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2011In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2012Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2013If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2014based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2015be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2016value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2017to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2018
2019On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2020@end defmac
2021
2022@node Values in Registers
2023@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2024
2025This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2026(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2027consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2028
2029@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2030A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2031at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2032@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2033cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2034and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2035
2036On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2037definition of this macro is
2038
2039@smallexample
2040#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2041 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2042 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2043@end smallexample
2044@end defmac
2045
2046@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2047A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2048in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2049in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2050multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2051this mode by the number of registers returned by
2052@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2053
2054For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2055registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2056nonzero.
2057
2058This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2059@code{subreg_get_info}
2060would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2061represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2062@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2063registers and so not be representable.
2064@end defmac
2065
2066@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2067For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2068@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2069returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2070including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2071@end defmac
2072
2073@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2074Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2075of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2076should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2077used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2078happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2079floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2080@end defmac
2081
2082@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2083A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2084of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2085registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2086are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2087
2088@smallexample
2089#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2090@end smallexample
2091
2092You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2093because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2094
2095@cindex register pairs
2096On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2097register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2098odd register numbers for such modes.
2099
2100The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2101@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2102register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2103value into the register and back out not alter it.
2104
2105Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2106all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2107@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2108you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2109is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2110and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2111to be tieable.
2112
2113Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2114Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2115in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2116can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2117mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2118registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2119
2120On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2121modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2122registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2123non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2124@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2125floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2126normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2127unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2128register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2129
2130The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2131they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2132instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2133@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2134constraints for those instructions.
2135
2136On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2137so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2138register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2139floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2140be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2141@end defmac
2142
2143@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2144A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2145@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2146
2147One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2148another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2149handler.
2150
2151The default is always nonzero.
2152@end defmac
2153
2154@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2155A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2156@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2157
2158If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2159@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2160any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2161should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2162this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2163accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2164
2165You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2166possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2167allocation.
2168@end defmac
2169
2170@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2171This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2172@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2173
2174One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2175is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2176
2177The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2178@end deftypefn
2179
2180@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2181Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2182registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2183@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2184@end defmac
2185
2186@node Leaf Functions
2187@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2188
2189@cindex leaf functions
2190@cindex functions, leaf
2191On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2192more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2193means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2194are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2195normally arrive.
2196
2197The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2198other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2199registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2200function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2201handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2202functions''.
2203
2204GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2205suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2206registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2207accomplish this.
2208
2209@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2210Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2211contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2212function treatment.
2213
2214If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2215registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2216GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2217used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2218in this vector.
2219
2220Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2221the treatment of leaf functions.
2222@end defmac
2223
2224@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2225A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2226should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2227
2228If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2229function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2230will cause the compiler to abort.
2231
2232Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2233treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2234this.
2235@end defmac
2236
2237@findex current_function_is_leaf
2238@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2239@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2240@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2241specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2242which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2243set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2244compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2245@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2246functions which only use leaf registers.
2247@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2248that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2249@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2250@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2251@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2252
2253@node Stack Registers
2254@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2255
2256There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2257``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2258pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2259stack.
2260
2261Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2262they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2263support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2264point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2265stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2266@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2267with it, as well as defining these macros.
2268
2269@defmac STACK_REGS
2270Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2271@end defmac
2272
2273@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2274This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2275the machine has any stack-like registers.
2276@end defmac
2277
2278@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2279The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2280of the stack.
2281@end defmac
2282
2283@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2284The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2285the stack.
2286@end defmac
2287
2288@node Register Classes
2289@section Register Classes
2290@cindex register class definitions
2291@cindex class definitions, register
2292
2293On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2294For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2295certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2296restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2297
2298You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2299which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2300that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2301
2302@findex ALL_REGS
2303@findex NO_REGS
2304In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2305class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2306class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2307union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2308
2309@findex GENERAL_REGS
2310One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2311terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2312@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2313the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2314to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2315
2316Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2317then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2318
2319The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2320constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2321You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2322them in operand constraints.
2323
6049a4c8
HPN
2324You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2325registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2326some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2327cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2328(@pxref{Costs}).
2329
38f8b050
JR
2330You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2331instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2332either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2333certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
b899fd78
JR
2334which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2335or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
dd5a833e 2336class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
38f8b050
JR
2337
2338You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2339classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2340contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2341in their union.
2342
2343When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2344certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2345Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2346a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2347specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2348
2349Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2350instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2351each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2352mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2353single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2354this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2355instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2356single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2357@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2358
2359@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2360An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2361as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2362must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2363@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2364tells how many classes there are.
2365
2366Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2367the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2368in many of the tables described below.
2369@end deftp
2370
2371@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2372The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2373
2374@smallexample
2375#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2376@end smallexample
2377@end defmac
2378
2379@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2380An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2381constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2382@end defmac
2383
2384@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2385An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2386which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2387@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2388register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2389
2390When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2391Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2392several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2393for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2394In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2395registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2396so on.
2397@end defmac
2398
2399@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2400A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2401@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2402which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2403register.
2404@end defmac
2405
2406@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2407A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2408base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2409which is the register value plus a displacement.
2410@end defmac
2411
2412@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2413This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2414the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2415@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2416@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2417@end defmac
2418
2419@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2420A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2421base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2422register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2423addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2424@end defmac
2425
2426@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2427A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2428base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2429context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2430the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2431address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2432@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2433index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2434@end defmac
2435
2436@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2437A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2438index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2439address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2440added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2441@end defmac
2442
2443@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2444A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2445suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
38f8b050
JR
2446@end defmac
2447
2448@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2449A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2450that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2451@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2452reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2453you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2454@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2455addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2456@code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2457@end defmac
2458
2459@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2460A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2461use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2462memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2463pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2464define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2465than other base register uses.
2466
2467Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2468@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
38f8b050
JR
2469@end defmac
2470
2471@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2472A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2473that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2474appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2475immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2476address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2477@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2478corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2479@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2480that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2481@end defmac
2482
2483@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2484A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2485suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2486either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2487allocated such a hard register.
2488
2489The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2490the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2491two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2492labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2493labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2494may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2495looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2496only if neither labeling works.
38f8b050
JR
2497@end defmac
2498
5f286f4a
YQ
2499@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS
2500
fba42e24
AS
2501@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2502A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2503to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2504@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2505another, smaller class.
2506
2507The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2508
2509Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2510example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2511for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2512@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2513Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2514
2515One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2516@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2517loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2518force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2519immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2520instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2521register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2522@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2523into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35 2524@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
fba42e24
AS
2525of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2526
2527If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2528through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2529to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2530reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2531this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2532the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2533@end deftypefn
2534
38f8b050
JR
2535@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2536A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2537to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2538@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2539another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2540safe:
2541
2542@smallexample
2543#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2544@end smallexample
2545
2546Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2547example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2548for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2549@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2550Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2551
2552One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2553@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2554loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2555force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2556immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2557instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2558register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2559@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2560into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35
RS
2561@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2562of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
38f8b050
JR
2563
2564If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2565through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2566to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2567reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2568this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2569the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2570@end defmac
2571
abd26bfb
AS
2572@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2573Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2574input reloads.
2575
2576The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2577argument.
2578
2579You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2580reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2581@end deftypefn
2582
38f8b050
JR
2583@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2584A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2585to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2586@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2587ordinarily be used.
2588
2589Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2590there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2591
2592The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2593smaller class.
2594
2595Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2596require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2597@end defmac
2598
2599@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2600Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2601from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2602@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2603from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2604term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2605directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2606register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2607destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2608source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2609reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2610and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2611intermediate register still holds the required value.
2612
2613Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2614allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2615register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2616address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2617when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2618as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2619that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2620describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2621these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2622of the scratch register(s).
2623
2624In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2625
2626For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2627and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2628@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2629hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2630needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2631
2632If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2633an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2634return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2635If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2636If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2637that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2638
2639If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2640perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2641closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2642required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2643copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2644
2645You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2646in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2647and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2648for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2649single-register-class
2650@c [later: or memory]
2651output constraint.
2652
2653When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2654hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2655register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2656have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2657
2658@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2659@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2660@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2661@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2662@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2663@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2664@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2665@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2666
2667
2668@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2669pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2670Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2671in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2672
2673Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2674currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2675to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2676
2677@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2678copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2679(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2680Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2681of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2682forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2683@end deftypefn
2684
2685@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2686@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2687@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2688These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2689@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2690
2691These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2692target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2693reload phase that it may
2694need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2695register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2696register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2697you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2698largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2699intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2700
2701If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2702intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2703was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2704class required. If the
2705requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2706@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2707macros identically.
2708
2709The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2710Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2711can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2712@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2713macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2714
2715If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2716intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2717@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2718(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2719implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2720@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2721register.
2722
2723These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2724register that
2725contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2726class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2727value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2728register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2729Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2730
2731@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2732pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2733Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2734in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2735
2736These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2737registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2738registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2739would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2740the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2741intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2742general registers.
2743@end defmac
2744
2745@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2746Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2747to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2748those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2749@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2750class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2751and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2752
2753Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2754@end defmac
2755
2756@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2757Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2758allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2759If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2760defined by this macro.
2761
2762Do not define this macro if you do not define
2763@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2764@end defmac
2765
2766@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2767When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2768registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2769hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2770load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2771same as that of @var{mode}.
2772
2773This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2774bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2775in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2776registers.
2777
2778However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2779the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2780differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2781widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2782suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2783details.
2784
2785Do not define this macro if you do not define
2786@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2787is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2788@end defmac
2789
07b8f0a8
AS
2790@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2791A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2792to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2793registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2794
2795The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2796has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2797default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2798if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2799hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2800@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2801@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2802register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2803you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2804the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2805allocation.
2806@end deftypefn
a8c44c52
AS
2807
2808@hook TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2809A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2810of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2811
2812This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
1c7836f0 2813the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
a8c44c52
AS
2814@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2815@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2816values in the class @var{rclass}.
2817
2818This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2819in the reload pass.
2820
2821The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2822in words.
2823@end deftypefn
07b8f0a8 2824
38f8b050
JR
2825@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2826A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2827of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2828
2829This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2830the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2831should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2832@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2833
2834This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2835in the reload pass.
2836@end defmac
2837
2838@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2839If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2840a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2841
2842For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2843floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2844Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2845does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2846register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2847as below:
2848
2849@smallexample
2850#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2851 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2852 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2853@end smallexample
2854@end defmac
2855
38f8b050
JR
2856@node Old Constraints
2857@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2858@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2859@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2860
2861Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2862of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2863Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2864it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2865
2866@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2867For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2868@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2869constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2870you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2871constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2872DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2873to handle specially.
2874There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2875for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2876transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2877return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2878will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2879@end defmac
2880
2881@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2882A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2883letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2884value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2885the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2886corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2887to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2888@end defmac
2889
2890@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2891Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2892passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2893different variants.
2894@end defmac
2895
2896@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2897A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2898letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2899particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2900letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2901the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2902not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2903@var{value}.
2904@end defmac
2905
2906@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2907Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2908string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2909between different variants.
2910@end defmac
2911
2912@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2913A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2914letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2915(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2916
2917If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2918@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2919range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2920letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2921
2922@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2923@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2924or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2925between these kinds.
2926@end defmac
2927
2928@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2929Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2930string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2931between different variants.
2932@end defmac
2933
2934@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2935A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2936letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2937memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2938elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2939@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2940may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2941
2942If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2943if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2944constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2945constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2946
2947For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2948in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2949letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2950@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2951a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2952alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2953does not include r0 on the output.
2954@end defmac
2955
2956@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2957Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2958in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2959variants.
2960@end defmac
2961
2962@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2963A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2964letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2965be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2966
2967It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2968at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2969comprises a subset of all memory references including
2970all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2971pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2972type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2973
2974For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2975memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2976register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2977@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2978If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2979a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2980reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2981into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2982an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2983@end defmac
2984
2985@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2986A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2987letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2988@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2989be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2990
2991It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2992at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2993a subset of all memory addresses including
2994all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
2995pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2996type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
2997
2998Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
2999be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3000analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3001@end defmac
3002
3003@node Stack and Calling
3004@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3005@cindex calling conventions
3006
3007@c prevent bad page break with this line
3008This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3009
3010@menu
3011* Frame Layout::
3012* Exception Handling::
3013* Stack Checking::
3014* Frame Registers::
3015* Elimination::
3016* Stack Arguments::
3017* Register Arguments::
3018* Scalar Return::
3019* Aggregate Return::
3020* Caller Saves::
3021* Function Entry::
3022* Profiling::
3023* Tail Calls::
3024* Stack Smashing Protection::
3025@end menu
3026
3027@node Frame Layout
3028@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3029@cindex stack frame layout
3030@cindex frame layout
3031
3032@c prevent bad page break with this line
3033Here is the basic stack layout.
3034
3035@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3036Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3037pointer to a smaller address.
3038
3039When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3040compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3041definition used does not matter.
3042@end defmac
3043
3044@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3045This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3046on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3047@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3048
3049The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3050and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3051the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3052to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3053space for the next item on the stack.
3054
3055The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3056defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3057which is often wrong.
3058@end defmac
3059
3060@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3061Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3062are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3063@end defmac
3064
3065@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3066Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3067addresses on the stack.
3068@end defmac
3069
3070@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3071Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3072
3073If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3074subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3075Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3076value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3077@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3078@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3079@end defmac
3080
3081@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3082Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3083The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3084
3085On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3086is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3087alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3088stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3089@end defmac
3090
3091@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3092Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3093outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3094zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3095
3096If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3097the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3098@end defmac
3099
3100@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3101Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3102address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3103function.
3104
3105If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3106the first argument's address.
3107@end defmac
3108
3109@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3110Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3111on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3112
3113The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3114length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3115machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3116@end defmac
3117
3118@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3119A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3120stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3121@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3122default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3123elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3124@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3125@end defmac
3126
3127@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3128A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3129frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3130@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3131itself.
3132
3133If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3134of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3135address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3136@end defmac
3137
3138@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3139If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3140setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3141on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3142before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3143define this macro.
3144@end defmac
3145
3146@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3147This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3148the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3149The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3150machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3151@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3152@end deftypefn
3153
3154@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3155A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3156address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3157of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3158You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3159as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3160@end defmac
3161
3162@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3163A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3164address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3165the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3166frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3167@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3168
3169The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3170@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3171determine the return address of other frames.
3172@end defmac
3173
3174@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3175Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3176from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3177@end defmac
3178
3179@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3180A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3181incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3182prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3183value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3184the stack.
3185
3186You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3187debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3188
3189If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3190@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3191@end defmac
3192
3193@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3194A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3195number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3196must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3197be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3198
3199This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3200general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3201frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3202over time.
3203@end defmac
3204
3205@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3206A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3207number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3208only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3209someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3210terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3211@end defmac
3212
3213@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3214This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3215contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3216info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3217@smallexample
3218(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3219@end smallexample
3220and
3221@smallexample
3222(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3223@end smallexample
3224to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3225the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3226the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3227@end deftypefn
3228
3229@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3230A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3231from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3232frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3233the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3234previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3235
3236You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3237debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3238@end defmac
3239
3240@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3241A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3242from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3243final value should coincide with that calculated by
3244@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3245during virtual register instantiation.
3246
3247The default value for this macro is
3248@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3249which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3250immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3251some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3252and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3253
3254You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3255want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3256DWARF 2.
3257@end defmac
3258
3259@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3260If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3261in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3262The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3263@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3264
3265Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3266via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3267variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3268defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3269based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3270of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3271should be defined.
3272@end defmac
3273
3274@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3275If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3276in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3277in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3278may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3279@end defmac
3280
3281@node Exception Handling
3282@subsection Exception Handling Support
3283@cindex exception handling
3284
3285@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3286A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3287data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3288@var{N} registers are usable.
3289
3290The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3291handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3292should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3293but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
32942 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3295
3296You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3297handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3298@end defmac
3299
3300@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3301A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3302to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3303This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3304It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3305
3306Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3307untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3308
3309Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3310by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3311this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3312stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3313this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3314that provided by DWARF 2.
3315@end defmac
3316
3317@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3318A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3319to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3320return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3321
3322Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3323return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3324address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3325the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3326frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3327been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3328target call frame.
3329
3330Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3331address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3332the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3333
3334If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3335define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3336@end defmac
3337
3338@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3339If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3340to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3341exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3342using it to return to the exception handler.
3343@end defmac
3344
3345@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3346This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3347handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3348that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3349and so may be read-only.
3350
3351@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3352@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3353The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3354as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3355
3356If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3357represented directly.
3358@end defmac
3359
3360@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3361This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3362to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3363Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3364be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3365
3366This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3367handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3368of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3369to be emitted.
3370@end defmac
3371
38f8b050
JR
3372@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3373This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3374code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3375available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3376through signal frames.
3377
3378This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3379@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3380@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3381@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3382for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3383the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3384save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3385evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3386the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3387
3388For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3389@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3390@end defmac
3391
3392@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3393This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3394call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3395usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3396
3397This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3398@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3399@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3400for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3401@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3402be updated in @var{fs}.
3403@end defmac
3404
3405@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3406A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3407info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3408linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3409@end defmac
3410
3411@node Stack Checking
3412@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3413
3414GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3415stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3416three ways:
3417
3418@enumerate
3419@item
3420If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3421will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3422at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3423other special processing.
3424
3425@item
3426If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3427@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3428that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3429static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3430in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3431stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3432approach below.
3433
3434@item
3435If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3436``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3437@end enumerate
3438
3439If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3440GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3441@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3442dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3443
3444@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3445A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3446machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3447is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3448checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3449value of this macro is zero.
3450@end defmac
3451
3452@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3453A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3454in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3455like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3456approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3457@end defmac
3458
3459@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3460An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3461instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3462define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3463the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3464of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3465@end defmac
3466
3467@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3468An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3469when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3470contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3471thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3472is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3473default value of this macro is zero.
3474@end defmac
3475
3476@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3477The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3478languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3479with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
34808192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3481most machines.
3482@end defmac
3483
3484The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3485nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3486in the opposite case.
3487
3488@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3489The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3490instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3491stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3492checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3493default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3494systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3495@end defmac
3496
3497@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3498GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3499represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3500space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3501You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3502use the default of four words.
3503@end defmac
3504
3505@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3506The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3507fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3508@option{-fstack-check}.
3509GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3510normally not need to override that default.
3511@end defmac
3512
3513@need 2000
3514@node Frame Registers
3515@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3516
3517@c prevent bad page break with this line
3518This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3519
3520@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3521The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3522fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3523the hardware determines which register this is.
3524@end defmac
3525
3526@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3527The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3528access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3529hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3530choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3531@end defmac
3532
3533@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3534On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3535offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3536allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3537between these two locations). On those machines, define
3538@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3539be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3540@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3541used for the frame pointer.
3542
3543You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3544is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3545the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3546completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3547definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3548@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3549or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3550
3551Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3552@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3553@end defmac
3554
3555@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3556The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3557the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3558frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3559register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3560wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3561pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3562@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3563(@pxref{Elimination}).
3564@end defmac
3565
e3339d0f
JM
3566@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3567Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3568@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3569the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3570== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3571definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3572@end defmac
3573
3574@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3575Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3576@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3577same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3578ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3579definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3580@end defmac
3581
38f8b050
JR
3582@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3583The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3584access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3585machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3586pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3587to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3588@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3589
3590Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3591address from the stack.
3592@end defmac
3593
3594@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3595@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3596Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3597register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3598function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3599number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3600these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3601not be defined.
3602
3603The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3604
3605If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3606defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3607@end defmac
3608
3609@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3610This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3611targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3612nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3613attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3614those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3615
3616The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3617
3618If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3619provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3620Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3621from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3622will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3623@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3624@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3625@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3626The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3627@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3628to refer to those items.
3629@end deftypefn
3630
3631@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3632This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3633saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3634DWARF2 exception handling.
3635
3636Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3637exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3638extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3639in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3640used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3641routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3642registers that are not call-saved.
3643
3644If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3645@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3646@end defmac
3647
3648@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3649
3650This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3651for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3652
3653If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3654@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3655@end defmac
3656
3657@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3658
3659Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3660is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3661Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3662column number to use instead.
3663
3664See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3665@end defmac
3666
3667@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3668
3669Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3670used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3671debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3672should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3673@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3674
3675@end defmac
3676
3677@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3678
3679Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3680that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3681should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3682.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3683return @code{@var{regno}}.
3684
3685@end defmac
3686
cca2207a
L
3687@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3688
3689Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3690@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3691target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3692default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3693
3694@end defmac
3695
3696@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3697
3698Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3699context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3700it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3701defined and 0 otherwise.
3702
3703@end defmac
3704
38f8b050
JR
3705@node Elimination
3706@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3707
3708@c prevent bad page break with this line
3709This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3710
3711@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3712This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3713a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3714value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3715
3716This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3717according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3718constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3719to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3720Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3721pointer.
3722
3723In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3724without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3725automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3726@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3727them.
3728
3729In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3730register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3731fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3732
3733Default return value is @code{false}.
3734@end deftypefn
3735
3736@findex get_frame_size
3737@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3738A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3739between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3740the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3741such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3742registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3743
3744If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3745need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3746@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3747case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3748@end defmac
3749
3750@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3751If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3752eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3753defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3754references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3755
3756The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3757of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3758
3759On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3760the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3761must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3762replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3763depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3764
3765In this case, you might specify:
3766@smallexample
3767#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3768@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3769 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3770 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3771@end smallexample
3772
3773Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3774specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3775@end defmac
3776
3777@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3778This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3779try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3780@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3781is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3782preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3783knows about.
3784
3785Default return value is @code{true}.
3786@end deftypefn
3787
3788@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3789This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3790specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3791registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3792defined.
3793@end defmac
3794
3795@node Stack Arguments
3796@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3797@cindex arguments on stack
3798@cindex stack arguments
3799
3800The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3801on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3802control passing certain arguments in registers.
3803
3804@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3805This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3806prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3807passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3808cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3809The default is to not promote prototypes.
3810@end deftypefn
3811
3812@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3813A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3814outgoing arguments.
3815If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3816That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3817allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3818it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3819@end defmac
3820
3821@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3822A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3823last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3824defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3825and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3826@end defmac
3827
3828@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3829A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3830stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3831
3832On some machines, the definition
3833
3834@smallexample
3835#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3836@end smallexample
3837
3838@noindent
3839will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3840to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3841alignment. Then the definition should be
3842
3843@smallexample
3844#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3845@end smallexample
4a6336ad 3846
64ad7c99 3847If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
3848@end defmac
3849
3850@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3851@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3852A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3853will be computed and placed into the variable
3854@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3855onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3856increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3857
3858Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3859is not proper.
3860@end defmac
3861
3862@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3863Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3864allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3865registers.
3866
3867The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3868arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3869which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3870The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3871of the function.
3872
3873This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3874machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3875which.
3876@end defmac
3877@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3878@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3879
3880@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3881Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3882caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3883when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3884if the function called is a library function.
3885
3886If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3887whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3888@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3889@end defmac
3890
3891@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3892Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3893stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3894@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3895@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3896
3897Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3898stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3899suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3900stack in its natural location.
3901@end defmac
3902
893d13d5 3903@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
38f8b050
JR
3904This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3905a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3906and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3907
3908@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3909the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3910@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3911From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3912
3913@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3914describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3915@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3916From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3917arguments (if known).
3918
3919When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3920will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3921you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3922by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3923a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3924in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3925
893d13d5 3926@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
38f8b050
JR
3927stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3928argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3929
3930On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3931of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
38f8b050
JR
3932calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3933the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3934convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3935arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3936nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3937@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3938number of arguments.
3939@end deftypefn
3940
3941@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3942A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3943pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3944when compiling a function call.
3945
3946@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3947have been accumulated.
3948
3949On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3950that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3951that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3952call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3953appropriate.
3954@end defmac
3955
3956@node Register Arguments
3957@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3958@cindex arguments in registers
3959@cindex registers arguments
3960
3961This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3962types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3963the stack.
3964
b25b9e8f
NF
3965@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
3966Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3967register and if so, which register.
38f8b050 3968
b25b9e8f 3969The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
38f8b050
JR
3970arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3971the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3972(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
b25b9e8f
NF
3973which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3974nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3975function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3976syntax error has previously occurred.
38f8b050 3977
b25b9e8f
NF
3978The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3979register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3980on the stack.
38f8b050
JR
3981
3982The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3983used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3984@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3985@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3986describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3987@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3988register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3989register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3990second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3991the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3992As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3993RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3994argument is also stored on the stack.
3995
b25b9e8f 3996The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
38f8b050
JR
3997VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3998pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3999
4000@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
b25b9e8f
NF
4001The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4002machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4003cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4004done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4005@var{named} is @code{false}.
4006
4007@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4008@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
4009You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4010in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4011type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
b25b9e8f 4012is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
38f8b050
JR
4013argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4014defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4015a register.
b25b9e8f 4016@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4017
4018@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4019This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4020solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4021definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4022documentation.
4023@end deftypefn
4024
b25b9e8f
NF
4025@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
4026Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
38f8b050
JR
4027that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4028necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4029argument.
4030
b25b9e8f
NF
4031For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4032which the caller passes the value, and
4033@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4034fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4035arrive.
38f8b050 4036
b25b9e8f
NF
4037If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4038@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4039@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4040
4041@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4042This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4043argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4044arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4045pushed on the stack.
4046
4047On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4048registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4049first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4050on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4051structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4052in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4053compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4054
b25b9e8f 4055@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
38f8b050 4056register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
b25b9e8f 4057@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
38f8b050
JR
4058@end deftypefn
4059
ec9f85e5 4060@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
38f8b050
JR
4061This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4062position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4063predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4064passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4065
4066If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4067pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4068The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4069to that type.
4070@end deftypefn
4071
4072@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4073The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4074known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4075function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4076by the caller.
4077
4078For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4079determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4080not be generated.
4081
4082The default version of this hook always returns false.
4083@end deftypefn
4084
4085@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
b25b9e8f
NF
4086A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4087of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4088target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4089of bytes of argument so far.
38f8b050
JR
4090
4091There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4092arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4093variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4094arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4095@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4096should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4097@end defmac
4098
4099@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4100If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4101function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4102created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4103reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4104If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4105@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4106@end defmac
4107
4108@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4109A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4110@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4111variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4112is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4113the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4114For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4115declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4116@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4117being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4118arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4119parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4120@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4121
4122When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4123@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4124contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4125an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4126macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4127never both of them at once.
4128@end defmac
4129
4130@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4131Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4132it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4133@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4134is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41350)} is used instead.
4136@end defmac
4137
4138@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4139Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4140finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4141undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4142
4143The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4144with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4145argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4146@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4147@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4148@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4149@end defmac
4150
b25b9e8f
NF
4151@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
4152This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4153advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4154@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4155the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4156argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
38f8b050 4157
b25b9e8f 4158This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
38f8b050
JR
4159on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4160used for arguments without any special help.
b25b9e8f 4161@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4162
4163@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4164If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4165offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4166which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4167slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4168top.
4169@end defmac
4170
4171@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4172If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4173to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4174@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4175@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4176
123148b5
BS
4177The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4178target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4179always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
38f8b050
JR
4180
4181This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4182For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4183big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4184constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4185@end defmac
4186
4187@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4188If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4189implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4190next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4191controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4192arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4193@end defmac
4194
4195@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4196Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4197memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4198macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4199machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4200@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4201registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4202a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4203required.
4204@end defmac
4205
c2ed6cf8 4206@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
2b0d3573 4207This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
c2ed6cf8
NF
4208with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4209@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4210@end deftypefn
38f8b050 4211
123148b5
BS
4212@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY
4213
38f8b050
JR
4214@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4215A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4216register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4217@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4218the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4219used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4220stack.
4221@end defmac
4222
4223@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4224This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4225as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4226arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4227to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4228AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4229registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4230point register.
4231
4232The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4233false.
4234@end deftypefn
4235
4236@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4237This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4238The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4239@end deftypefn
4240
07a5b2bc 4241@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
38f8b050
JR
4242This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4243to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4244variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4245to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
38f8b050 4246variable.
07a5b2bc 4247The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
38f8b050
JR
4248this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4249internal type.
4250If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4251Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4252macro to iterate through all types.
4253@end deftypefn
4254
4255@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4256This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4257@var{fndecl}.
4258The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4259@end deftypefn
4260
4261@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4262This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4263type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4264@code{NULL_TREE}.
4265@end deftypefn
4266
4267@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4268This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4269@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4270arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4271@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4272@end deftypefn
4273
4274@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4275Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4276with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4277hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4278@end deftypefn
4279
7352c013
RG
4280@hook TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO
4281
38f8b050
JR
4282@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4283Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4284insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4285considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4286must work.
4287
4288The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4289required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4290Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4291code in @file{optabs.c}.
4292@end deftypefn
4293
4294@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4295Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4296insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4297must have move patterns for this mode.
4298@end deftypefn
4299
0f6d54f7
RS
4300@hook TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4301
38f8b050
JR
4302@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4303Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4304small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4305@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4306in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4307In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4308for any mode.
4309
4310On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4311insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4312to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4313if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4314insn.
4315
4316Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4317in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4318the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4319classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4320registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4321registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4322SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4323strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4324machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4325
2b0d3573 4326The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
38f8b050
JR
4327safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4328unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4329that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4330to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4331of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4332@end deftypefn
4333
e692f276
RH
4334@hook TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4335
38f8b050
JR
4336@node Scalar Return
4337@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4338@cindex return values in registers
4339@cindex values, returned by functions
4340@cindex scalars, returned as values
4341
4342This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4343values---values that can fit in registers.
4344
4345@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4346
4347Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4348returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4349representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4350representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4351function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4352compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4353Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4354a function returns a value.
4355
4356On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4357(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4358place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4359@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4360The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
b25b9e8f 4361multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
38f8b050
JR
4362@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4363location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4364the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4365that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4366port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4367@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4368
4369If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4370the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4371@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4372
4373If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4374node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4375pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4376convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4377known.
4378
4379Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4380which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4381the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4382different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4383
4384@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4385aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4386@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4387@end deftypefn
4388
4389@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4390This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4391a new target instead.
4392@end defmac
4393
4394@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4395A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4396function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4397
4398Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4399support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4400specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4401compiled.
4402@end defmac
4403
4404@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4405Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
ff2ce160 4406function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
38f8b050
JR
4407
4408The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
ff2ce160 4409library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
38f8b050
JR
4410representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4411
4412If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4413@end deftypefn
4414
4415@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4416A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4417register in which the values of called function may come back.
4418
4419A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4420second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4421recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4422suffices:
4423
4424@smallexample
4425#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4426@end smallexample
4427
4428If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4429function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4430should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4431
4432This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4433for a new target instead.
4434@end defmac
4435
4436@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4437A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4438register in which the values of called function may come back.
4439
4440A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4441second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4442recognized by this target hook.
4443
4444If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4445function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4446should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4447
4448If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4449@end deftypefn
4450
4451@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4452Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4453need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4454saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4455@end defmac
4456
4457@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4458This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4459at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4460padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4461is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4462
4463Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4464be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4465or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44664-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4467@code{SImode} rtx.
4468@end deftypefn
4469
4470@node Aggregate Return
4471@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4472@cindex aggregates as return values
4473@cindex large return values
4474@cindex returning aggregate values
4475@cindex structure value address
4476
4477When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4478cases), the value is not returned according to
4479@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4480caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4481should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4482address}.
4483
4484This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4485memory.
4486
4487@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4488This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4489function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4490Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4491will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4492libcalls.
4493
4494Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4495by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4496takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4497possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4498definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4499values, and 0 otherwise.
4500
4501Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4502be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4503to indicate this.
4504@end deftypefn
4505
4506@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4507Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4508in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4509only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4510If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4511and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4512target hook.
4513
4514If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4515@end defmac
4516
4517@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4518This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4519address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4520passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4521be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4522hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4523argument.
4524
4525On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4526is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4527caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4528be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4529@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4530the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4531the caller.
4532
4533If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4534stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4535@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4536structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4537to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4538@end deftypefn
4539
4540@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4541Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4542for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4543the address of a static variable containing the value.
4544
4545Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4546pass an address to the subroutine.
4547
4548This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4549nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4550@end defmac
4551
ffa88471
SE
4552@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4553
4554@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4555
38f8b050
JR
4556@node Caller Saves
4557@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4558
4559If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4560makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4561must live across calls.
4562
4563@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4564A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4565a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4566restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4567this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4568
4569If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4570machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4571@end defmac
4572
4573@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4574A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4575of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4576@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4577returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4578will select the smallest suitable mode.
4579@end defmac
4580
4581@node Function Entry
4582@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4583@cindex function entry and exit
4584@cindex prologue
4585@cindex epilogue
4586
4587This section describes the macros that output function entry
4588(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4589
4590@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4591If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4592function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4593initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4594saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4595local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4596stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4597
4598The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4599macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4600
4601@findex regs_ever_live
4602To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4603@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4604@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4605prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4606call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4607@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4608
4609On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4610not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4611they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4612appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4613registers are used in the function.
4614
4615@findex frame_pointer_needed
4616On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4617function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4618pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4619frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4620@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4621time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4622
4623The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4624required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4625listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4626order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4627stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4628the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4629for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4630compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4631or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4632need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4633@end deftypefn
4634
4635@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4636If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4637prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4638emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4639emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4640@end deftypefn
4641
4642@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4643If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4644epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4645emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4646emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4647@end deftypefn
4648
4649@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4650If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4651function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4652registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4653called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4654same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4655registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4656@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4657
4658On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4659of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4660instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4661@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4662
4663Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4664@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4665switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4666define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4667target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4668condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4669
4670On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4671function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4672two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4673is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4674@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4675a function that needs a frame pointer.
4676
4677Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4678@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4679The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4680function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4681
4682On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4683others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4684given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4685number of arguments.
4686
4687@findex current_function_pops_args
4688Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4689functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4690needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4691function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4692@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4693@end deftypefn
4694
4695@itemize @bullet
4696@item
4697@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4698A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4699uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4700stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4701if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4702arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4703yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4704region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4705registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4706features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4707
4708@item
4709An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4710The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4711the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4712machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4713in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4714a save area.
4715
4716@item
4717A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4718boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4719this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4720save area closer to the top of the stack.
4721
4722@item
4723@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4724Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4725@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4726argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4727@end itemize
4728
4729@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4730Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4731instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4732pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4733adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4734default is 0.
4735
4736Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4737frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4738stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4739compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4740@end defmac
4741
4742@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4743Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4744used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4745pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4746@end defmac
4747
4748@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4749Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4750used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4751on entry to an exception edge.
4752@end defmac
4753
4754@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4755Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4756instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4757definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4758representing the number of delay slots there.
4759@end defmac
4760
4761@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4762A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4763slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4764
4765The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4766being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4767eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4768of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4769If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4770may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4771(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4772slot.
4773
4774@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4775@findex final_scan_insn
4776The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4777list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4778@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4779delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4780@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4781outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4782@code{final_scan_insn}.
4783
4784You need not define this macro if you did not define
4785@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4786@end defmac
4787
4788@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4789A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4790function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4791inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4792adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4793the real function.
4794
4795First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4796contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4797contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4798in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4799e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4800all other incoming arguments.
4801
4802Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4803made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4804adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4805
4806@smallexample
4807p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4808@end smallexample
4809
4810After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4811@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4812not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4813return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4814
4815The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4816the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4817of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4818and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4819
4820The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4821have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4822some targets, but probably not.
4823
4824If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4825front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4826@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4827not support varargs.
4828@end deftypefn
4829
4830@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4831A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4832to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4833arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4834generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4835previously exposed.
4836@end deftypefn
4837
4838@node Profiling
4839@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4840@cindex profiling, code generation
4841
4842These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4843
4844@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4845A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4846assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4847
4848@findex mcount
4849The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4850your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4851compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4852compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4853
4854Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4855variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4856@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4857the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4858@end defmac
4859
4860@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4861A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4862code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4863not support profiling.
4864@end defmac
4865
4866@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4867Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4868@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4869allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4870implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4871@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4872@end defmac
4873
4874@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4875Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4876the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4877@end defmac
4878
4879@node Tail Calls
4880@subsection Permitting tail calls
4881@cindex tail calls
4882
4883@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4884True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4885call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4886or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4887
4888It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4889tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4890during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4891as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4892``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4893may vary greatly between different architectures.
4894@end deftypefn
4895
4896@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4897Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4898function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4899cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4900registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4901TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4902FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4903@end deftypefn
4904
4905@node Stack Smashing Protection
4906@subsection Stack smashing protection
4907@cindex stack smashing protection
4908
4909@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4910This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4911for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4912runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4913that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4914variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4915
4916The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4917@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4918@end deftypefn
4919
4920@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4921This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4922stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4923involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4924
4925The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4926@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4927normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4928@end deftypefn
4929
7458026b
ILT
4930@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4931
38f8b050
JR
4932@node Varargs
4933@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4934@cindex varargs implementation
4935
4936GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4937@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4938on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4939varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4940conditionals to include it.
4941
4942ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4943the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4944implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4945to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4946@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4947supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4948
4949However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4950the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4951below.
4952
4953@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4954Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4955that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4956versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4957you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4958
4959On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4960control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4961other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4962found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4963
4964Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4965beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4966@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4967This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4968to use them for its own purposes.
4969@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4970@c 10feb93
4971@end defmac
4972
38f8b050 4973@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4974This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
38f8b050
JR
4975argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4976returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4977argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4978fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4979verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4980of the current function.
4981@end defmac
4982
4983@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4984Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4985passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4986has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4987specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4988with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4989
4990@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4991considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4992kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4993
4994The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4995interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4996@end defmac
4997
4998These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4999
5000@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
5001If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5002@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5003beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5004return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5005to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5006@end deftypefn
5007
5008@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
5009This target hook offers an alternative to using
5010@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5011@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5012register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5013have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5014use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5015pass all their arguments on the stack.
5016
5017The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5018structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5019named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5020last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5021
5022The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5023argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5024store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5025variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5026store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5027frame.
5028
5029Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5030compile time without knowing their data types,
5031@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5032have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5033for all data types.
5034
5035If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5036arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5037happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5038end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5039not generate any instructions in this case.
5040@end deftypefn
5041
5042@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5043Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5044argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5045
b25b9e8f 5046This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
5047is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5048@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5049arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5050but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5051then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5052except the last are treated as named.
5053
5054You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5055@end deftypefn
5056
5057@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5058If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5059@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5060@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5061defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5062@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5063Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5064@end deftypefn
5065
5066@node Trampolines
5067@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5068@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5069@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5070
5071A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5072when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5073the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5074tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5075trampoline.
5076
5077The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5078address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5079the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5080two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5081exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5082machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5083two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5084operands.
5085
5086The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5087parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5088immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5089simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5090proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5091may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5092separately.
5093
5094@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5095This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5096on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5097the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5098label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5099
5100If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5101for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5102code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5103to generate it on the spot.
5104@end deftypefn
5105
5106@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5107Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5108(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5109@end defmac
5110
5111@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5112A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5113@end defmac
5114
5115@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5116Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5117
5118If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5119is used for aligning trampolines.
5120@end defmac
5121
5122@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5123This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5124@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5125is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5126RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5127when it is called.
5128
5129If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5130first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5131from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
ff2ce160 5132Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
38f8b050
JR
5133trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5134to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5135
5136If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
ff2ce160 5137enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
38f8b050
JR
5138initializing the trampoline proper.
5139@end deftypefn
5140
5141@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5142This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5143the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5144memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5145the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5146address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5147be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5148If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5149@end deftypefn
5150
5151Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5152separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5153fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5154jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5155
5156Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5157the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5158make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5159subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5160latter makes initialization faster.
5161
5162To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5163the following macro.
5164
5165@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5166If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5167cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5168typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5169@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5170@end defmac
5171
38f8b050
JR
5172To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5173you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5174cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5175beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5176its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5177
5178@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5179Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5180work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5181which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5182@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5183
5184If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5185C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5186special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5187statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5188global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5189special assembler code.
5190@end defmac
5191
5192@node Library Calls
5193@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5194@cindex library subroutine names
5195@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5196
5197@c prevent bad page break with this line
5198Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5199
5200@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5201This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5202expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5203provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5204are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5205@end defmac
5206
5207@findex set_optab_libfunc
5208@findex init_one_libfunc
5209@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5210This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5211existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5212@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5213@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5214library routines.
5215
5216The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5217@end deftypefn
5218
cdbf4541
BS
5219@hook TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5220
38f8b050
JR
5221@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5222This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5223implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5224mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5225return a tristate.
5226
5227GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5228comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5229don't need to define this macro.
5230@end defmac
5231
5232@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5233This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5234functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5235operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5236and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5237If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5238@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5239in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5240@end defmac
5241
38f8b050
JR
5242@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5243@findex matherr
5244@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5245The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5246expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5247deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5248@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5249system.
5250
5251If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5252domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5253error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5254there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5255that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5256@end defmac
5257
5258@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5259@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5260Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5261refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5262@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5263macro, a reasonable default is used.
5264@end defmac
5265
5266@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5267@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5268When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5269@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5270default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5271functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5272systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5273@end defmac
5274
5275@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5276@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5277When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5278and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5279default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5280@smallexample
5281void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5282void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5283void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5284@end smallexample
5285@end defmac
5286
5287@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5288Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5289the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5290involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5291at once to the method-lookup library function.
5292
5293The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5294to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5295@end defmac
5296
5297@node Addressing Modes
5298@section Addressing Modes
5299@cindex addressing modes
5300
5301@c prevent bad page break with this line
5302This is about addressing modes.
5303
5304@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5305@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5306@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5307@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5308A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5309pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5310@end defmac
5311
5312@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5313@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5314A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5315post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5316the size of the memory operand.
5317@end defmac
5318
5319@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5320@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5321A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5322post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5323@end defmac
5324
5325@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5326A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5327is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5328@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5329is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
ff2ce160 5330constant addresses are supported.
38f8b050
JR
5331@end defmac
5332
5333@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5334@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5335accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5336known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5337expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5338@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5339@end defmac
5340
5341@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5342A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5343memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5344the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5345accept.
5346@end defmac
5347
5348@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5349A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5350address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5351
5352Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5353non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5354desired by the caller.
5355
5356The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5357that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5358considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5359kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5360must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5361up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5362register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5363if the array holds @code{-1}.
5364
5365The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5366accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5367register is required.
5368
5369Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5370and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5371constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5372specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5373recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5374
5375Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5376sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5377@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5378naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5379be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5380
5381@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5382On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5383the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5384target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5385into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5386@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5387@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5388Format}.
5389
5390@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5391Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5392this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5393has this syntax:
5394
5395@example
5396#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5397@end example
5398
5399@noindent
5400and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5401address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5402
5403@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5404Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5405macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5406@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5407that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5408
38f8b050
JR
5409Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5410files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5411@end deftypefn
5412
5413@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5414A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5415character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5416letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5417@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5418support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5419semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5420preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5421@code{'m'} constraint.
5422@end defmac
5423
5424@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5425A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5426or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5427can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5428@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5429
5430It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5431that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5432
5433The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5434a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5435@end defmac
5436
5437@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5438This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5439operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5440address.
5441
5442@findex break_out_memory_refs
5443@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5444and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5445@var{x}.
5446
5447The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5448@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5449should return the new @var{x}.
5450
5451It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5452The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5453is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5454a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5455strategy can generate better code.
5456@end deftypefn
5457
5458@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5459A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5460that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5461@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5462It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5463performance reasons.
5464
5465For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5466reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5467registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5468processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5469needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5470@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5471generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5472be shared.
5473
5474@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5475to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5476and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5477of reload internals.
5478
5479@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5480previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5481then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5482
5483@findex push_reload
5484The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5485need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5486suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5487
5488The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5489@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5490should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5491This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5492@code{push_reload}.
5493
5494@findex strict_memory_address_p
5495The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5496the address has become legitimate.
5497
5498@findex copy_rtx
5499If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5500this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5501single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5502top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5503It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5504address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5505@end defmac
5506
5507@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5508This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5509different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5510reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5511but not others.
5512
5513Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5514effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5515of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5516addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5517
5518You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5519
5520The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5521@end deftypefn
5522
5523@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5524A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5525@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5526different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5527reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5528but not others.
5529
5530Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5531effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5532of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5533addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5534
5535You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5536
5537These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5538@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5539@end defmac
5540
1a627b35
RS
5541@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
5542This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5543@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5544@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5545
5546The default definition returns true.
5547@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
5548
5549@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5550This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5551@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5552macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5553references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5554addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5555the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5556into their original form.
5557@end deftypefn
5558
5559@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5560This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
fbbf66e7
RS
5561should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5562of @var{x}.
5563
5564The default version of this hook returns false.
38f8b050
JR
5565
5566The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5567deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5568from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5569holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5570of TLS symbols for various targets.
5571@end deftypefn
5572
5573@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5574This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5575be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5576of @var{x}.
5577
5578The default version returns false for all constants.
5579@end deftypefn
5580
89356d17 5581@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
38f8b050
JR
5582This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5583the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5584@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5585when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5586@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5587of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5588function are valid.
5589@end deftypefn
5590
5591@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5592This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5593address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5594used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5595@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5596
5597The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5598@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5599the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5600@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5601two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5602@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5603the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5604from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5605@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5606@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5607@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5608
5609If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5610to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5611use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5612@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5613should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5614described above.
5615If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5616the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5617log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5618@end deftypefn
5619
5620@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5621This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5622widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5623
5624If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5625@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5626widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5627preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5628@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5629@end deftypefn
5630
5631@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5632This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5633widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5634
5635If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5636@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5637widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5638preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5639@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5640@end deftypefn
5641
5642@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5643Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
ff2ce160 5644For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
720f5239 5645misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
38f8b050
JR
5646@end deftypefn
5647
5648@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5649Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5650@end deftypefn
5651
5652@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5653Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5654@end deftypefn
5655
5656@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5657Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5658@end deftypefn
5659
5660@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5661This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5662input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5663The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5664specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5665(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5666
5667If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5668@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5669conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5670@end deftypefn
5671
5672@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5673This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5674vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5675@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5676The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5677return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5678@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5679@end deftypefn
5680
5681@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5682This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5683store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5684parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5685the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5686parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5687@end deftypefn
5688
cc4b5170
RG
5689@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5690This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5691mode @var{mode}. The default is
5692equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5693transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5694@end deftypefn
5695
767f865f
RG
5696@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5697This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5698after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5699mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5700The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5701@end deftypefn
5702
38f8b050
JR
5703@node Anchored Addresses
5704@section Anchored Addresses
5705@cindex anchored addresses
5706@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5707
5708GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5709For example, if we have:
5710
5711@smallexample
5712static int a, b, c;
5713int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5714@end smallexample
5715
5716the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5717addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5718it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5719the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5720be something like:
5721
5722@smallexample
5723int foo (void)
5724@{
5725 register int *xr = &x;
5726 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5727@}
5728@end smallexample
5729
5730(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5731``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5732
5733The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5734in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5735section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5736or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5737
5738@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5739The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5740On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5741applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5742for every mode. The default value is 0.
5743@end deftypevr
5744
5745@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5746Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5747offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5748value is 0.
5749@end deftypevr
5750
5751@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5752Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5753@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5754The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5755of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5756
5757If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5758it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5759If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5760is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5761@end deftypefn
5762
5763@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5764Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5765@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5766@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5767
5768The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5769intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5770or target-specific sections.
5771@end deftypefn
5772
5773@node Condition Code
5774@section Condition Code Status
5775@cindex condition code status
5776
5777The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5778two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5779
5780The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5781(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5782clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5783register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5784architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5785most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5786most RISC machines.
5787
5788The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5789the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5790insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5791optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5792is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5793three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5794scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5795separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5796
5797For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5798represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5799condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5800condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5801or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5802Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5803that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5804
5805Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5806specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5807interested in most macros in this section.
5808
5809@menu
5810* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5811* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
ac7eb5c6 5812* Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
38f8b050
JR
5813@end menu
5814
5815@node CC0 Condition Codes
5816@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5817@findex cc0
5818
5819@findex cc_status
5820The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5821describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5822the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5823variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5824currently based, and several standard flags.
5825
5826Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5827description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5828information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5829
5830@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5831C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5832component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5833
5834This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5835@end defmac
5836
5837@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5838A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5839The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5840the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5841define this macro to initialize it.
5842
5843This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5844@end defmac
5845
5846@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5847A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5848appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5849this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5850code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5851set @code{(cc0)}.
5852
5853This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5854
5855If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5856other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5857invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5858reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5859registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5860@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5861insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5862based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5863value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5864this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5865@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5866@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5867condition code value.
5868
5869The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5870with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5871@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5872constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5873insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5874@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5875@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5876
5877A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5878that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5879@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5880two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5881@end defmac
5882
5883@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5884@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5885@findex CCmode
5886@findex MODE_CC
5887
5888@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5889On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5890than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5891code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5892when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5893bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5894branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5895this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5896record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5897also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5898unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5899
5900If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5901@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5902a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5903have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5904by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5905be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5906the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5907
5908@smallexample
5909(define_insn ""
5910 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5911 (compare:CC_NOOV
5912 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5913 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5914 (const_int 0)))]
5915 ""
5916 "@dots{}")
5917@end smallexample
5918
5919@noindent
5920together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5921for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5922
5923@smallexample
5924#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5925 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5926 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5927 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5928 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5929 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5930@end smallexample
5931
5932Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5933were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5934this section.
5935
5936You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5937in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5938@end defmac
5939
5940@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5941On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5942convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5943does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5944comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5945
5946On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5947required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5948and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5949comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5950@var{op1} as required.
5951
5952GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5953valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5954@file{md} file.
5955
5956You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5957code or operands.
5958@end defmac
5959
5960@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5961A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5962comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5963can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5964then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5965
5966You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5967floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5968For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5969inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5970
5971@smallexample
5972#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5973@end smallexample
5974@end defmac
5975
5976@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5977A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5978comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5979@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5980machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5981instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5982freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5983like:
5984
5985@smallexample
5986#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5987 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5988 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5989@end smallexample
5990@end defmac
5991
5992@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
5993On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
5994register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
5995regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
5996hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
5997small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
5998to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
5999arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6000When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6001integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6002@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6003
6004The default version of this hook returns false.
6005@end deftypefn
6006
6007@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6008On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6009@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6010validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6011target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6012both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6013return @code{VOIDmode}.
6014
6015The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6016same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6017returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6018@end deftypefn
6019
ac7eb5c6 6020@node Cond Exec Macros
38f8b050
JR
6021@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6022@findex conditional execution
6023@findex predication
6024
6025There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6026supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6027represent conditional branches.
6028
6029@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6030A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6031@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6032versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6033predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6034that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6035If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6036
6037@smallexample
6038#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6039 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6040@end smallexample
6041@end defmac
6042
6043@node Costs
6044@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6045@cindex costs of instructions
6046@cindex relative costs
6047@cindex speed of instructions
6048
6049These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6050on the target machine.
6051
6052@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6053A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6054register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6055expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6056value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6057that.
6058
6059It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6060same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6061registers if they are not general registers.
6062
6063If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6064hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6065classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6066constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6067allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6068if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6069
6070These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6071@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6072@end defmac
6073
6074@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6075This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6076from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6077are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6078A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6079that.
6080
6081It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6082same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6083registers if they are not general registers.
6084
6085If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6086hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6087classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6088constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6089allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6090if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6091
6092The default version of this function returns 2.
6093@end deftypefn
6094
6095@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6096A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6097register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6098is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6099is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6100registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6101should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6102
6103If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6104the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6105needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6106between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6107more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6108reflect the actual cost of the move.
6109
6110GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6111secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6112a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6113secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61144 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6115value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6116are the same as to this macro.
6117
6118These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6119@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6120@end defmac
6121
911852ff 6122@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
38f8b050 6123This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6124between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
38f8b050
JR
6125if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6126This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6127If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6128registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6129
6130If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6131the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6132needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6133between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
38f8b050
JR
6134more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6135reflect the actual cost of the move.
6136
6137GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6138secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6139a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6140secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61414 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6142value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6143are the same as to this target hook.
6144@end deftypefn
6145
6146@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
525d13b0
MS
6147A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6148the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6149@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6150for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6151optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6152true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6153@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
38f8b050
JR
6154@end defmac
6155
6156Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6157but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6158ordinarily expect.
6159
6160@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6161Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6162than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6163faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6164require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6165between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6166
6167When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6168finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6169load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6170faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6171may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6172other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6173@end defmac
6174
6175@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6176Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6177@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6178than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6179handler.
6180
6181When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6182@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6183moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6184Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6185cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6186
6187If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6188this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6189@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6190@end defmac
6191
6192@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6193The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6194which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6195string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6196make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6197
6198Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6199@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6200the number of such sequences.
6201
6202The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6203optimized for speed rather than size.
6204
6205If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6206@end defmac
6207
6208@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6209A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6210copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6211will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6212than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6213@end defmac
6214
6215@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6216A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6217a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6218@end defmac
6219
6220@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6221The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6222of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6223or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6224eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6225
6226The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6227optimized for speed rather than size.
6228
6229If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6230@end defmac
6231
6232@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6233A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6234to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6235will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6236than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6237@end defmac
6238
6239@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6240The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6241of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
ff2ce160 6242a block set insn or a library call.
38f8b050
JR
6243Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6244eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6245
6246The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6247optimized for speed rather than size.
6248
6249If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6250@end defmac
6251
6252@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6253A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
ff2ce160
MS
6254used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6255other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
38f8b050
JR
6256storing values other than constant zero.
6257Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6258than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6259@end defmac
6260
6261@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6262A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6263used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6264other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6265called with a constant source string.
6266Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6267than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6268@end defmac
6269
6270@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6271A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6272thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6273@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6274@end defmac
6275
6276@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6277A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6278thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6279@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6280@end defmac
6281
6282@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6283A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6284thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6285@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6286@end defmac
6287
6288@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6289A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6290thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6291@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6292@end defmac
6293
6294@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6295A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6296thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6297@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6298@end defmac
6299
6300@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6301A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6302thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6303@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6304@end defmac
6305
6306@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6307This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6308thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6309@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6310@end defmac
6311
6312@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6313This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6314thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6315@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6316@end defmac
6317
6318@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6319Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6320function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6321@end defmac
6322
6323@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6324Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6325@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6326@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6327@end defmac
6328
6329@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6330This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6331
6332The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
68f932c4
RS
6333available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6334as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6335That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6336that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6337either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6338(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6339
6340@var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6341obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
38f8b050
JR
6342
6343In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6344@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6345instructions.
6346
6347On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6348for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6349necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6350for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6351operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6352
6353When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6354false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6355size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6356
6357The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6358processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6359@end deftypefn
6360
6361@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6362This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6363@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6364the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6365
6366For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6367true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6368instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6369all addresses will have equal costs.
6370
6371In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6372the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6373cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6374
6375For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6376and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6377is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6378references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6379the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6380that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6381instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6382specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6383
6384This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6385
6386On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6387cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6388@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6389be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6390@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6391should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6392should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6393registers on machines with lots of registers.
6394@end deftypefn
6395
6396@node Scheduling
6397@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6398
6399The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6400adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6401hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6402them: try the first ones in this list first.
6403
6404@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6405This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6406issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6407Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6408an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6409constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6410hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6411This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6412it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6413@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6414@end deftypefn
6415
6416@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6417This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6418from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6419still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6420@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6421@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6422You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6423than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6424@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6425debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6426@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6427was scheduled.
6428@end deftypefn
6429
6430@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6431This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6432relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6433dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6434is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6435to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6436that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6437data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6438description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6439output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6440times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6441acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6442@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6443@end deftypefn
6444
6445@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6446This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6447@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6448execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6449later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6450scheduling priorities of insns.
6451@end deftypefn
6452
6453@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6454This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6455list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6456combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6457@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6458debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6459@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6460list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6461a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6462reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6463@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6464is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6465the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6466can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6467@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6468@end deftypefn
6469
6470@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6471Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6472function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6473is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6474@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6475return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6476this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6477scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6478cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6479@end deftypefn
6480
6481@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6482This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6483chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6484correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6485example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6486analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6487dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6488calculated.
6489@end deftypefn
6490
6491@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6492This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6493instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6494pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6495is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6496@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6497region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6498scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6499@end deftypefn
6500
6501@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6502This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6503instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6504cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6505is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6506to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6507@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6508@end deftypefn
6509
6510@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6511This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6512@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6513@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6514@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6515@end deftypefn
6516
6517@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6518This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6519@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6520@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6521@end deftypefn
6522
6523@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6524The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6525pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6526when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6527simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6528processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6529based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6530when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6531@end deftypefn
6532
6533@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6534The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6535@end deftypefn
6536
6537@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6538The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6539to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6540simulated processor cycle finishes.
6541@end deftypefn
6542
6543@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6544The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6545used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6546@end deftypefn
6547
6548@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6549The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6550The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6551to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6552state on a single insn is not enough.
6553@end deftypefn
6554
6555@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6556The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6557The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6558to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6559state on a single insn is not enough.
6560@end deftypefn
6561
6562@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6563This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6564for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6565chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6566value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6567@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6568subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6569maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6570@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6571packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6572rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6573
6574This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6575processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6576with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6577@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6578@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6579processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6580@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6581until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6582the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6583
6584Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6585pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6586schedules to choose the best one.
6587
6588The default is no multipass scheduling.
6589@end deftypefn
6590
6591@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6592
6593This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6594considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6595zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6596be issued.
6597
6598The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6599@end deftypefn
6600
894fd6f2
MK
6601@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6602This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6603scheduling.
6604@end deftypefn
6605
6606@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6607This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6608@end deftypefn
6609
6610@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6611This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6612an instruction.
6613@end deftypefn
6614
6615@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6616This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6617round of multipass scheduling.
6618@end deftypefn
6619
6620@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
2b0d3573 6621This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6622@end deftypefn
6623
6624@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
2b0d3573 6625This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6626@end deftypefn
6627
c06bbdf7 6628@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
38f8b050
JR
6629This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6630on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6631@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6632the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6633is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6634start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6635verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6636@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6637processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6638and the current processor cycle.
6639@end deftypefn
6640
6641@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6642This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6643the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6644are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6645to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6646being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6647dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6648parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6649The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6650insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6651and @code{false} otherwise.
6652
6653Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6654where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6655delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6656that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6657important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6658closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6659not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6660@end deftypefn
6661
6662@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6663This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6664the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6665per instruction data structures.
6666@end deftypefn
6667
6668@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6669Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6670@end deftypefn
6671
6672@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6673Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6674It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6675beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6676@end deftypefn
6677
6678@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6679Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6680@end deftypefn
6681
6682@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6683Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6684@end deftypefn
6685
6686@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6687Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6688@end deftypefn
6689
6690@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6691This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6692speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6693The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6694version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6695pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6696or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6697speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6698the generated speculative pattern.
6699@end deftypefn
6700
6701@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6702This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6703for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6704instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6705@end deftypefn
6706
6707@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6708This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6709check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6710speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6711@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6712be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6713recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6714a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6715@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6716@end deftypefn
6717
6718@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6719This hook is used as a workaround for
6720@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6721called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6722discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6723being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6724@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6725For non-speculative instructions,
6726the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6727the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6728is nearly full.
6729@end deftypefn
6730
6731@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6732This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6733enabled/used.
6734The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6735The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6736@end deftypefn
6737
6738@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6739This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6740resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6741the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6742backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6743bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6744of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6745@end deftypefn
6746
7942e47e
RY
6747@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6748This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6749is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6750@end deftypefn
6751
6752@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6753This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6754in its second parameter.
6755@end deftypefn
6756
b0bd15f7
BS
6757@hook TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6758
df7b0cc4
EI
6759@hook TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH
6760
38f8b050
JR
6761@node Sections
6762@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6763@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6764@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6765
6766An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6767data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6768section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6769section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6770section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6771of sections.
6772
6773@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6774@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6775The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6776is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6777as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6778initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6779They may however depend on command-line flags.
6780
6781@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6782use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6783to be string literals.
6784
6785Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6786section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6787should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6788@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6789
6790You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6791@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6792in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6793@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6794create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6795reuse @code{text_section}.
6796
6797All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6798if the target does not provide them.
6799
6800@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6801A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6802assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6803Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6804@end defmac
6805
6806@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6807If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6808frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6809a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6810@end defmac
6811
6812@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6813If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6814executed functions in the program.
6815@end defmac
6816
6817@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6818A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6819assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6820data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6821@end defmac
6822
6823@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6824If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6825containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6826initialized, writable small data.
6827@end defmac
6828
6829@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6830A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6831assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6832data.
6833@end defmac
6834
6835@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6836If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6837containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
07c5f94e
AS
6838uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6839@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
38f8b050
JR
6840uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6841@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6842used.
6843@end defmac
6844
6845@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6846If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6847containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6848uninitialized, writable small data.
6849@end defmac
6850
6851@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6852If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6853assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6854common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6855@end defmac
6856
6857@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6858If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6859containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6860default is @code{'T'}.
6861@end defmac
6862
6863@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6864If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6865containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6866initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6867not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6868variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6869@end defmac
6870
6871@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6872If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6873containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6874finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6875not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6876variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6877@end defmac
6878
6879@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6880If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6881containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6882part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6883defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6884both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6885@end defmac
6886
6887@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6888If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6889containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6890part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6891defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6892both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6893@end defmac
6894
6895@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6896If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6897via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6898the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6899@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6900to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6901sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6902ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6903registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6904constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6905@end defmac
6906
6907@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6908If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6909variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6910when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6911you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6912they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6913expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6914MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6915require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6916to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6917access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6918@end defmac
6919
6920@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6921If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6922arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6923@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6924and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6925@end defmac
6926
6927@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6928Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6929tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6930section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6931readonly data section is used.
6932
6933This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6934@end defmac
6935
6936@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6937Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6938@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6939of its own that you need to create.
6940
6941GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6942any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6943described below.
6944@end deftypefn
6945
6946@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6947Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6948selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6949should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6950local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6951
6952The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6953is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6954when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6955in read-only sections even in executables.
6956@end deftypefn
6957
6958@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6959Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6960assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6961some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6962requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6963local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6964@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6965
6966The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6967variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6968
6969See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6970@end deftypefn
6971
6972@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6973Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6974for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6975
6976In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6977function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6978it is unlikely to be called.
6979@end defmac
6980
6981@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6982Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6983and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6984As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6985the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6986
6987The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6988ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6989example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6990Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
6991@end deftypefn
6992
6993@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
6994Return the readonly data section associated with
6995@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6996The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
6997the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
6998if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
6999otherwise.
7000@end deftypefn
7001
727a65e6
BS
7002@hook TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7003
38f8b050
JR
7004@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7005Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7006should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7007constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7008case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7009in bits.
7010
7011The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7012constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7013else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7014@end deftypefn
7015
7016@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7017Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7018by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7019the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7020or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7021hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7022your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7023returns the @var{id} provided.
7024@end deftypefn
7025
7026@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7027Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7028treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7029function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7030
7031The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7032@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7033an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7034rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7035in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7036
7037In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7038a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7039will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7040register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7041rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7042leave it alone.)
7043
7044The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7045that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7046be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7047declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7048declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7049@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7050
7051@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7052The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7053@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7054Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7055encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7056discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7057
7058The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7059in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7060@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7061before overriding it.
7062@end deftypefn
7063
7064@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7065Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7066the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7067may have added.
7068@end deftypefn
7069
7070@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7071Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7072The default version of this hook always returns false.
7073@end deftypefn
7074
7075@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7076Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7077``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7078@end deftypevr
7079
3c5273a9
KT
7080@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7081
38f8b050
JR
7082@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7083Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7084rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7085or executable image).
7086
7087The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7088for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7089currently supported object file formats.
7090@end deftypefn
7091
7092@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7093Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7094The default value is false.
7095@end deftypevr
7096
7097
7098@node PIC
7099@section Position Independent Code
7100@cindex position independent code
7101@cindex PIC
7102
7103This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7104independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7105generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7106@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7107@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7108must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7109when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7110need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7111relative addresses.
ff2ce160 7112@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
38f8b050
JR
7113@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7114
7115@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7116The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7117data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7118processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7119is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7120pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7121is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7122necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7123when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7124@end defmac
7125
7126@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7127A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7128@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7129the default is zero. Do not define
38f8b050
JR
7130this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7131@end defmac
7132
7133@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7134A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7135operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7136You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7137check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7138check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7139(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7140position independent code.
7141@end defmac
7142
7143@node Assembler Format
7144@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7145
7146This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7147to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7148instructions do.
7149
7150@menu
7151* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7152* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7153* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7154* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7155* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7156 and termination routines.
7157* Macros for Initialization::
7158 Specific macros that control the handling of
7159 initialization and termination routines.
7160* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7161* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7162* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7163* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7164@end menu
7165
7166@node File Framework
7167@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7168@cindex assembler format
7169@cindex output of assembler code
7170
7171@c prevent bad page break with this line
7172This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7173
7174@findex default_file_start
7175@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7176Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7177find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7178by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7179quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7180@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7181lets other target files rely on these variables.
7182@end deftypefn
7183
7184@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7185If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7186printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7187@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7188to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7189definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7190assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7191whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7192
7193The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7194verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7195comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7196@end deftypevr
7197
7198@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7199If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7200for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7201@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7202this to be done. The default is false.
7203@end deftypevr
7204
7205@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7206Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7207to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7208@end deftypefn
7209
7210@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7211Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7212special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7213the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7214should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7215need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7216this function.
7217@end deftypefun
7218
7219@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7220Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7221to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7222nothing.
7223@end deftypefn
7224
7225@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7226Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7227to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7228nothing.
7229@end deftypefn
7230
7231@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7232Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7233unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7234here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7235because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7236nothing.
7237@end deftypefn
7238
7239@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7240A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7241assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7242the end of the line.
7243@end defmac
7244
7245@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7246A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7247statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7248@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7249assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7250that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7251@end defmac
7252
7253@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7254A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7255statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7256@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7257time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7258@end defmac
7259
7260@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7261A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7262which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7263the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7264
7265This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7266for the file format in use is appropriate.
7267@end defmac
7268
b5f5d41d
AS
7269@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7270
38f8b050
JR
7271@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7272A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7273@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7274in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7275the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7276of the filename using this macro.
7277@end defmac
7278
7279@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7280A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7281@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7282macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7283@end defmac
7284
7285@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7286Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7287should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7288of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7289is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7290this section is associated.
7291@end deftypefn
7292
f16d3f39
JH
7293@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
7294Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7295Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
ff2ce160 7296functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
f16d3f39
JH
7297at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7298@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7299(from static destructors).
7300Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7301@end deftypefn
7302
14d11d40
IS
7303@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS
7304
38f8b050
JR
7305@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7306This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
d5fabb58 7307It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
7308@end deftypevr
7309
7310@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7311@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7312This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7313section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7314This is true on most ELF targets.
7315@end deftypevr
7316
7317@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7318Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7319based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7320declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7321null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7322
7323The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7324read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7325need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7326set via @code{__attribute__}.
7327@end deftypefn
7328
7329@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7330Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7331switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7332enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7333It can take the following values:
7334
7335@table @gcctabopt
7336@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7337@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7338
7339@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7340@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7341direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7342default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7343command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7344various different individual optimization passes.
7345
7346@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7347@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7348ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7349target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7350time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7351warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7352wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7353necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7354perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7355switches.
7356
7357@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7358This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7359
7360@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7361This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7362@end table
7363
7364The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7365supported in the future.
7366
7367By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7368provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7369it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7370section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7371provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7372hook.
7373@end deftypefn
7374
7375@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7376This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7377ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7378hook.
7379@end deftypevr
7380
7381@need 2000
7382@node Data Output
7383@subsection Output of Data
7384
7385
7386@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7387@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7388@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7389@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7390@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7391@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7392@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7393@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7394@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7395These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7396of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7397byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7398aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7399@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7400
7401The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7402followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7403the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7404@end deftypevr
7405
7406@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7407The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7408integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7409in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7410function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7411object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7412split the object into smaller parts.
7413
7414The default implementation of this hook will use the
7415@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7416when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7417@end deftypefn
7418
6cbd8875
AS
7419@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7420A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7421can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7422the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7423@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7424
7425If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7426so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7427itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7428return @code{true}.
7429@end deftypefn
7430
38f8b050
JR
7431@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7432A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7433instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7434bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7435@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7436
7437If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7438Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7439@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7440@end defmac
7441
7442@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7443A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7444@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7445is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7446@end defmac
7447
7448@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7449You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7450expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7451pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7452GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7453not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7454pool before the function.
7455@end defmac
7456
7457@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7458A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7459constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7460the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7461be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7462is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7463immediately after this call.
7464
7465If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7466not be defined.
7467@end defmac
7468
7469@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7470A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7471constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7472anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7473
7474The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7475assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7476output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7477@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7478@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7479alignment.
7480
7481The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7482the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7483responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7484Here is how to do this:
7485
7486@smallexample
7487@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7488@end smallexample
7489
7490When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7491@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7492entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7493
7494You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7495@end defmac
7496
7497@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7498A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7499pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7500function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7501obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7502constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7503
7504If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7505define this macro.
7506@end defmac
7507
7508@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7509Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7510used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7511to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7512a line separator uses multiple characters.
7513
7514If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7515the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7516@end defmac
7517
7518@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7519These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7520assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7521default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7522@end deftypevr
7523
7524These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7525of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7526
7527@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7528@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7529@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7530@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7531@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7532@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7533These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7534target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7535the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7536@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7537simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7538@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7539by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7540it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
754132 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7542on the host machine.
7543
7544The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7545using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7546machine's memory.
7547@end defmac
7548
7549@node Uninitialized Data
7550@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7551
7552Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7553outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7554
7555@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7556A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7557@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7558@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7559is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7560possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7561other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7562backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7563byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7564equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7565the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7566an ordinary undefined external.
7567
7568Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7569output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7570assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7571
7572This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7573common global variables are output.
7574@end defmac
7575
7576@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7577Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7578separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7579place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7580handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7581as the number of bits.
7582@end defmac
7583
7584@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7585Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7586variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7587is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7588in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7589@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7590the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7591@end defmac
7592
07c5f94e 7593@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
38f8b050
JR
7594A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7595@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
07c5f94e
AS
7596@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7597is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
38f8b050 7598
07c5f94e
AS
7599Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7600@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
38f8b050
JR
7601@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7602before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7603the name, and a newline.
7604
07c5f94e 7605There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
38f8b050
JR
7606The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7607switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7608You do not need to do both.
7609
7610Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7611non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7612efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7613not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7614common in order to save space in the object file.
7615@end defmac
7616
38f8b050
JR
7617@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7618A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7619@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7620@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7621is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7622
7623Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7624output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7625assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7626
7627This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7628static variables are output.
7629@end defmac
7630
7631@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7632Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7633separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7634place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7635handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7636as the number of bits.
7637@end defmac
7638
7639@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7640Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7641variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7642is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7643in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7644@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7645the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7646@end defmac
7647
7648@node Label Output
7649@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7650
7651@c prevent bad page break with this line
7652This is about outputting labels.
7653
7654@findex assemble_name
7655@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7656A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7657@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7658Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7659output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7660assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7661definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7662@end defmac
7663
135a687e
KT
7664@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7665A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7666@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7667a function.
7668Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7669output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7670assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7671definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7672
7673If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7674usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7675@end defmac
7676
38f8b050
JR
7677@findex assemble_name_raw
7678@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7679Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7680to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7681@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7682that it is more efficient.
7683@end defmac
7684
7685@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7686A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7687size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7688default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7689systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7690
7691Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7692of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7693for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7694macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7695define this macro.
7696@end defmac
7697
7698@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7699A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7700@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7701symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7702If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7703provided.
7704@end defmac
7705
7706@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7707A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7708@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7709the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7710address.
7711
7712If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7713provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7714@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7715the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7716not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7717to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7718@end defmac
7719
7720@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7721A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7722type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7723default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7724systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7725
7726Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7727@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7728custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7729types at all, do not define this macro.
7730@end defmac
7731
7732@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7733A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7734the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7735default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7736the default is not to define this macro.
7737
7738Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7739@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7740custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7741types at all, do not define this macro.
7742@end defmac
7743
7744@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7745A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7746@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7747symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7748that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7749you should not count on this.
7750
7751If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7752definition of this macro is provided.
7753@end defmac
7754
7755@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7756A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7757@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7758function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7759outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7760@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
38f8b050
JR
7761@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7762
7763If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7764usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
38f8b050
JR
7765
7766You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7767of this macro.
7768@end defmac
7769
7770@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7771A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7772@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7773which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7774function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7775representing the function.
7776
7777If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7778
7779You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7780of this macro.
7781@end defmac
7782
7783@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7784A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7785@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7786initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7787label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7788@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7789
7790If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7791usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7792
7793You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7794@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7795@end defmac
7796
ad78130c 7797@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
38f8b050
JR
7798A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7799for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7800target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7801@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7802and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7803will be an internal label.
7804
7805The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7806usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7807
7808You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7809@end deftypefn
7810
7811@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7812A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7813@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7814for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7815
7816If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7817nothing.
7818@end defmac
7819
7820@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7821A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7822once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7823chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7824initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7825something about the size of the object.
7826
7827If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7828nothing.
7829
7830You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7831@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7832@end defmac
7833
7834@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7835This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7836@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7837that is, available for reference from other files.
7838
7839The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7840@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7841@end deftypefn
7842
7843@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7844This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7845@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7846global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7847
7848The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7849@end deftypefn
7850
7851@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7852A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7853@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7854that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7855no other definition is available. Use the expression
7856@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7857itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7858for making that name weak, and a newline.
7859
7860If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7861support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7862macro.
7863@end defmac
7864
7865@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7866Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7867@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7868or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7869should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7870defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7871@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7872to make @var{name} weak.
7873@end defmac
7874
7875@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7876Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7877symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7878declaration of @code{name}.
7879@end defmac
7880
7881@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7882A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7883supports weak symbols.
38f8b050
JR
7884
7885If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7886definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7887is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7888@end defmac
7889
7890@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7891A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7892
7893If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7894definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7895this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7896flag such as @option{-melf}.
38f8b050
JR
7897@end defmac
7898
7899@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7900A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7901public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7902be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7903format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7904section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7905requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7906@end defmac
7907
7908@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7909A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7910semantics.
7911
7912If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7913definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7914definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7915you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7916setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7917be emitted as one-only.
7918@end defmac
7919
7920@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7921This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7922commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7923hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7924@end deftypefn
7925
7926@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7927A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7928that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7929The default is @code{0}.
7930
7931Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7932if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7933will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7934symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7935thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7936(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7937with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7938
7939The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7940targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7941restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7942table of contents.
7943@end defmac
7944
7945@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7946A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7947@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7948symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7949not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7950declaration.
7951
7952This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7953The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7954@end defmac
7955
7956@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7957This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7958pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7959library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7960@end deftypefn
7961
7962@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7963This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7964directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7965.no_dead_code_strip directive.
7966@end deftypefn
7967
7968@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7969A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7970@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7971@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7972is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7973systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7974@end defmac
7975
77754180
DK
7976@hook TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7977
38f8b050
JR
7978@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7979A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7980@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7981will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7982to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7983encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
7984@end defmac
7985
7986@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
7987A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
7988result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
7989@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
7990This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
7991specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
7992when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
7993being taken.
7994@end defmac
7995
7996@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
7997A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
7998name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
7999
8000It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8001used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8002will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8003
8004It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8005object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8006should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8007beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8008convention your system uses, and follow it.
8009
8010The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8011@end deftypefn
8012
8013@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8014A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8015label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8016@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8017may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8018systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8019bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8020bundles.
8021
8022If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8023used.
8024@end defmac
8025
8026@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8027A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8028is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8029
8030This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8031produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8032with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8033
8034If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8035output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8036@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8037string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8038to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8039@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8040you should know what it does on your machine.)
8041@end defmac
8042
8043@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8044A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8045@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8046@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8047added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8048
8049The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8050produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8051@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8052assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8053macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8054internal static variables in different scopes.
8055
8056Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8057conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8058or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8059between the name and the number will suffice.
8060
8061If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8062which is correct for most systems.
8063@end defmac
8064
8065@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8066A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8067which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8068
8069@findex SET_ASM_OP
8070If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8071correct for most systems.
8072@end defmac
8073
8074@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8075A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8076which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8077to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8078be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8079the tree nodes are available.
8080
8081@findex SET_ASM_OP
8082If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8083correct for most systems.
8084@end defmac
8085
8086@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8087A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8088(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8089of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8090current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8091This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8092@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8093@end defmac
8094
8095@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8096A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8097which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8098@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8099an undefined weak symbol.
8100
8101Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8102@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8103@end defmac
8104
8105@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8106Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8107Objective-C methods.
8108
8109The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8110class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8111the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8112@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8113
8114These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8115the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8116systems define other ways of computing names.
8117
8118@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8119buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8120@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
812150 characters extra.
8122
8123The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8124method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8125@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8126in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8127
8128On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8129macro to provide more human-readable names.
8130@end defmac
8131
8132@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8133A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8134@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8135Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8136linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8137@end defmac
8138
8139@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8140A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8141@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8142unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8143whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8144@end defmac
8145
8146@node Initialization
8147@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8148@cindex initialization routines
8149@cindex termination routines
8150@cindex constructors, output of
8151@cindex destructors, output of
8152
8153The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8154(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8155data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8156to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8157@code{main} is called.
8158
8159Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8160@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8161terminates.
8162
8163To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8164must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8165be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8166system, you need to specify how to do this.
8167
8168There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8169initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8170Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8171
8172@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8173@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8174The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8175initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8176termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8177
8178Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
81790, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8180the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8181pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8182pointer containing zero.
8183
8184Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8185@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8186time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8187list; destructors in forward order.
8188
8189The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8190formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8191aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8192Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8193object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8194the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8195accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8196Termination functions are handled similarly.
8197
8198This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8199@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8200support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8201constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8202and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8203
8204When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8205upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8206support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8207parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8208program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8209
8210@smallexample
8211ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8212@end smallexample
8213
8214The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8215section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8216for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8217files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8218are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8219
8220The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8221compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8222fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8223to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8224of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8225that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8226
8227To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8228macro properly.
8229
8230If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8231@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8232entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8233it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8234after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8235in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8236
8237In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8238two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8239and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8240@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8241entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8242and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8243code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8244the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8245placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8246a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8247@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8248section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8249the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8250the initialization process.
8251
8252The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8253This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8254file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8255this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8256termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8257an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8258pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8259the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8260initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8261via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8262@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8263
8264@ifinfo
8265The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8266customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8267@end ifinfo
8268
8269@node Macros for Initialization
8270@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8271
8272Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8273and termination functions:
8274
8275@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8276If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8277operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8278defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8279using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8280macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8281run the initialization functions.
8282@end defmac
8283
8284@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8285If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8286This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8287on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8288be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8289@end defmac
8290
8291@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8292If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8293the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8294@end defmac
8295
8296@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8297If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8298the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8299@end defmac
8300
8301@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8302If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8303automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8304should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8305the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8306function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8307
8308This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8309shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8310exception tables embedded in the code.
8311@end defmac
8312
8313@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8314If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8315automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8316should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8317the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8318function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8319@end defmac
8320
8321@defmac INVOKE__main
8322If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8323@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8324where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8325useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8326@end defmac
8327
8328@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8329If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8330compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8331of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8332encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8333@end defmac
8334
8335@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8336This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8337collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8338It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8339@end deftypevr
8340
8341@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8342If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8343the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8344
8345Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8346no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8347priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8348otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8349
8350If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8351be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8352target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8353is not defined.
8354@end deftypefn
8355
8356@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8357This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8358functions rather than initialization functions.
8359@end deftypefn
8360
8361If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8362generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8363
8364If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8365constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8366an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8367
8368On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8369@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8370
8371@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8372Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8373object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8374object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8375
8376This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8377part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8378@end defmac
8379
8380@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8381Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8382to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8383@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8384@end defmac
8385
8386@defmac NM_FLAGS
8387@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8388constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8389passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
2b0d3573 8390are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
3e794bfe
RO
8391produces.
8392@end defmac
38f8b050
JR
8393
8394If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8395dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8396these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8397termination functions in shared libraries:
38f8b050
JR
8398
8399@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8400Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8401which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
38f8b050
JR
8402@end defmac
8403
8404@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8405Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8406of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8407of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8408from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8409code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8410line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8411@end defmac
8412
8413@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8414Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8415library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8416strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8417constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8418that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8419@end defmac
8420
8421@node Instruction Output
8422@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8423
8424@c prevent bad page break with this line
8425This describes assembler instruction output.
8426
8427@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8428A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8429registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8430register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8431@end defmac
8432
8433@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8434If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8435and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8436registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8437to registers using alternate names.
8438@end defmac
8439
0c6d290e
RE
8440@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8441If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8442name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8443machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8444names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8445declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8446@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8447register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8448
8449This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8450@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8451register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8452VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8453``s0'' and ``s1''.
8454@end defmac
8455
38f8b050
JR
8456@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8457Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8458requires different names for the machine instructions.
8459
8460The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8461assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8462macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8463points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8464written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8465opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8466increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8467so that it will not be output twice.
8468
8469In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8470name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8471that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8472care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8473@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8474
8475@findex recog_data.operand
8476If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8477elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8478
8479If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8480in the usual way.
8481@end defmac
8482
8483@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8484If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8485assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8486they will be output differently.
8487
8488Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8489extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8490elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8491The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8492template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8493by changing the contents of the vector.
8494
8495This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8496file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8497can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8498as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8499syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8500writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8501
8502If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8503@end defmac
8504
8505@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8506If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8507output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8508if necessary.
8509
8510Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8511extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8512elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8513The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8514template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8515by checking the contents of the vector.
8516@end deftypefn
8517
8518@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8519A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8520assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8521RTL expression.
8522
8523@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8524of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8525printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8526the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8527operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8528@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8529@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8530
8531@findex reg_names
8532If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8533The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8534@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8535@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8536
8537When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8538(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8539with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8540@var{code}.
8541@end defmac
8542
8543@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8544A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8545punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8546@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8547punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8548in this way.
8549@end defmac
8550
8551@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8552A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8553assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8554whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8555
8556@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8557On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8558section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8559@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8560@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8561Format}.
8562@end defmac
8563
8564@findex dbr_sequence_length
8565@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8566A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8567been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8568determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8569currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8570or whatever.
8571
8572Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8573reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8574explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8575@end defmac
8576
8577@findex final_sequence
8578Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8579prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8580(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8581found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8582processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8583being output.
8584
8585@findex asm_fprintf
8586@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8587@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8588@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8589@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8590If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8591@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8592@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8593support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8594files can define these macros differently.
8595@end defmac
8596
8597@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8598If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8599statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8600the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8601printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8602statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8603generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8604specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8605The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8606string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8607upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8608@end defmac
8609
8610@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8611If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8612different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8613numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8614first variant.
8615
8616If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8617@smallexample
8618@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8619@end smallexample
8620@noindent
8621in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8622first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8623@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8624@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8625within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8626alternatives within the braces than the value of
8627@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8628
8629If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8630@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8631operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8632
8633Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8634@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8635the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8636@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8637if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8638opcodes or operand order.
8639@end defmac
8640
8641@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8642A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8643which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8644The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8645profiling.
8646@end defmac
8647
8648@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8649A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8650which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8651The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8652profiling.
8653@end defmac
8654
8655@node Dispatch Tables
8656@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8657
8658@c prevent bad page break with this line
8659This concerns dispatch tables.
8660
8661@cindex dispatch table
8662@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8663A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8664pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8665@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8666definitions of these labels are output using
8667@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8668way here. For example,
8669
8670@smallexample
8671fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8672 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8673@end smallexample
8674
8675You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8676dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8677will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8678@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8679mode and flags can be read.
8680@end defmac
8681
8682@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8683This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8684in a dispatch table are absolute.
8685
8686The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8687@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8688a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8689definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8690For example,
8691
8692@smallexample
8693fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8694@end smallexample
8695@end defmac
8696
8697@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8698Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8699specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8700@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8701jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8702@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8703
8704This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8705for the table.
8706
8707If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8708@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8709@end defmac
8710
8711@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8712Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8713jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8714after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8715the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8716@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8717of the preceding label.
8718
8719If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8720the jump-table.
8721@end defmac
8722
8723@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8724This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8725should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8726should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8727function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8728The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8729exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8730true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8731
8732The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8733@end deftypefn
8734
8735@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8736This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8737It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8738to be broken up according to function.
8739
8740The default is that no label is emitted.
8741@end deftypefn
8742
a68b5e52
RH
8743@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8744
38f8b050
JR
8745@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8746This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8747given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8748returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
38f8b050
JR
8749@end deftypefn
8750
3bc6b3e6
RH
8751@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8752
38f8b050
JR
8753@node Exception Region Output
8754@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8755
8756@c prevent bad page break with this line
8757
8758This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8759region.
8760
8761@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8762If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8763exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8764provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8765@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8766
8767You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8768unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8769@end defmac
8770
8771@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8772If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8773data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8774might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8775collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8776
8777Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8778also defined.
8779@end defmac
8780
8781@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8782Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8783information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8784runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8785and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8786@end defmac
8787
8788@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8789An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8790that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8791@end defmac
8792
8793@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8794Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8795information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8796Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
f0a0390e
RH
8797@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8798or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8799@end defmac
38f8b050 8800
f0a0390e
RH
8801@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8802This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8803by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8804should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8805@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8806should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8807information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
38f8b050 8808
f0a0390e
RH
8809A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8810This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8811default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
38f8b050 8812
f0a0390e 8813Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
d5fabb58
JM
8814not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8815@var{opts}. In particular, the
f0a0390e
RH
8816setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8817macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8818depending on this setting.
8819
8820The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8821@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
d5fabb58
JM
8822@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8823@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8824must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
f0a0390e 8825@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8826
8827@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8828This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
d5fabb58
JM
8829tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8830command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
8831@end deftypevr
8832
38f8b050
JR
8833@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8834Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8835should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8836instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8837@end defmac
8838
8839@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8840This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8841function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8842@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8843alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8844minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8845the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8846@end defmac
8847
8848@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8849Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8850end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8851Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8852true otherwise.
8853@end deftypevr
8854
8855@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8856Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8857represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8858register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8859locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8860register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8861If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8862@end deftypefn
8863
8864@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8865If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8866multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8867sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8868It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8869filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8870@var{address} is the address of the table.
8871@end deftypefn
8872
8873@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8874This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8875the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8876if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8877reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8878@end deftypefn
8879
8880@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8881This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8882based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8883the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8884running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8885@end deftypevr
8886
8887@node Alignment Output
8888@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8889
8890@c prevent bad page break with this line
8891This describes commands for alignment.
8892
8893@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8894The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8895a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8896
8897This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8898to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8899define the macro.
8900
8901Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8902to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8903@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8904selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8905@end defmac
8906
ad0c4c36
DD
8907@hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8908The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8909@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8910@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8911@end deftypefn
8912
38f8b050
JR
8913@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8914The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8915a @code{BARRIER}.
8916
8917This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8918to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8919define the macro.
8920@end defmac
8921
ad0c4c36
DD
8922@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8923The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
38f8b050
JR
8924@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8925@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8926@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8927
8928@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8929The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8930a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8931
8932This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8933to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8934define the macro.
8935
8936Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8937to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8938@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8939selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8940@end defmac
8941
ad0c4c36
DD
8942@hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8943The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8944@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8945defined.
8946@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8947
8948@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8949The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8950If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8951the maximum of the specified values is used.
8952
8953Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8954to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8955@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8956selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8957@end defmac
8958
ad0c4c36
DD
8959@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8960The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8961to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8962is defined.
8963@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8964
8965@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8966A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8967instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8968Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8969expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8970@end defmac
8971
8972@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8973Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8974text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8975This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8976produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8977section.
8978@end defmac
8979
8980@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8981A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8982command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8983@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8984@end defmac
8985
8986@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8987Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8988for padding, if necessary.
8989@end defmac
8990
8991@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
8992A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8993command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8994@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
8995satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
8996a C expression of type @code{int}.
8997@end defmac
8998
8999@need 3000
9000@node Debugging Info
9001@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9002
9003@c prevent bad page break with this line
9004This describes how to specify debugging information.
9005
9006@menu
9007* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9008* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9009* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9010* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9011* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9012* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9013@end menu
9014
9015@node All Debuggers
9016@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9017
9018@c prevent bad page break with this line
9019These macros affect all debugging formats.
9020
9021@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9022A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9023register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9024of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9025some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9026versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9027compiler and another for DBX@.
9028
9029If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9030used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9031consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9032Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9033expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9034
9035If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9036does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9037redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9038@end defmac
9039
9040@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9041A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9042variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9043computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9044gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9045that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9046for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9047@option{-g} options is used.
9048@end defmac
9049
9050@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9051A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9052having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9053@var{offset}.
9054@end defmac
9055
9056@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9057A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9058produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9059this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9060debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9061@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9062@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9063
9064When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9065value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9066exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9067value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9068defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9069
9070The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9071user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9072@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9073@end defmac
9074
9075@node DBX Options
9076@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9077
9078@c prevent bad page break with this line
9079These are specific options for DBX output.
9080
9081@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9082Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9083in response to the @option{-g} option.
9084@end defmac
9085
9086@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9087Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9088in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9089@end defmac
9090
9091@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9092Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9093GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9094debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9095macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9096if there is any occasion to.
9097@end defmac
9098
9099@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9100Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9101in the text section.
9102@end defmac
9103
9104@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9105A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9106use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9107If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9108applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9109@end defmac
9110
9111@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9112A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9113use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9114value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9115@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9116information format.
9117@end defmac
9118
9119@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9120A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9121use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9122name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9123macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9124@end defmac
9125
9126@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9127Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9128@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9129describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9130On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9131@end defmac
9132
9133@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9134A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9135continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9136exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9137operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9138must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9139with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9140defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9141@end defmac
9142
9143@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9144Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9145the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9146a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9147constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9148if backslash is correct for your system.
9149@end defmac
9150
9151@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9152Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9153outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9154variable.
9155@end defmac
9156
9157@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9158The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9159for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9160@end defmac
9161
9162@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9163The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9164for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9165provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9166@end defmac
9167
9168@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9169The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9170for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9171``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9172@end defmac
9173
9174@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9175The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9176passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9177do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9178@end defmac
9179
9180@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9181Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9182arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9183in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9184code.
9185@end defmac
9186
9187@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9188Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9189the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9190relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9191an absolute address.
9192@end defmac
9193
9194@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9195Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9196the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9197start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9198@end defmac
9199
9200@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9201Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9202@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9203macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9204number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9205generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9206number for a type number.
9207@end defmac
9208
9209@node DBX Hooks
9210@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9211
9212@c prevent bad page break with this line
9213These are hooks for DBX format.
9214
9215@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9216Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9217information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9218argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9219@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9220@end defmac
9221
9222@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9223Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9224@end defmac
9225
9226@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9227Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9228output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9229@end defmac
9230
9231@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9232A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9233number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9234@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9235invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9236unique labels in the assembly output.
9237
9238This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9239if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9240@end defmac
9241
9242@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9243Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9244@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9245On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9246disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9247@end defmac
9248
9249@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9250Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9251extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9252feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9253@end defmac
9254
9255@node File Names and DBX
9256@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9257
9258@c prevent bad page break with this line
9259This describes file names in DBX format.
9260
9261@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9262A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9263@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9264file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9265This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9266
9267This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9268for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9269
9270It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9271text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9272to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9273@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9274@end defmac
9275
9276@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9277Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9278of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9279the beginning of the file.
9280@end defmac
9281
9282@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9283Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9284that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9285an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9286@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9287@end defmac
9288
9289@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9290A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9291compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9292written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9293
9294If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9295of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9296@end defmac
9297
9298@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9299Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9300@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9301the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9302whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9303@end defmac
9304
9305@need 2000
9306@node SDB and DWARF
9307@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9308
9309@c prevent bad page break with this line
9310Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9311
9312@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9313Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9314for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9315@end defmac
9316
9317@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9318Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9319debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9320
9321@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9322Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9323be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9324value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9325@end deftypefn
9326
9327To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9328define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9329@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9330prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9331as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9332@end defmac
9333
9334@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9335Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9336Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9337(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9338exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9339how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
38f8b050
JR
9340@end defmac
9341
f0a0390e
RH
9342@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9343This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9344unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9345@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9346return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9347
9348A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9349is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9350
9351A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9352This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9353@end deftypefn
9354
38f8b050
JR
9355@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9356Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9357line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9358tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9359@end defmac
9360
9730bc27
TT
9361@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9362
2ba42841
AO
9363@hook TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9364
9365@hook TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9366
38f8b050
JR
9367@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9368A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9369@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9370@end defmac
9371
9372@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9373A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9374between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9375slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9376@end defmac
9377
9378@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9379A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9380section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9381given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9382@end defmac
9383
9384@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9385A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9386reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9387@end defmac
9388
9389@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9390A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9391the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9392is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9393is referenced by a function.
9394@end defmac
9395
9396@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9397If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9398reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9399@end deftypefn
9400
9401@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9402Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9403SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9404macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9405not define them yourself.
9406@end defmac
9407
9408@defmac SDB_DELIM
9409Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9410SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9411delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9412a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9413required.
9414@end defmac
9415
9416@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9417Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9418union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9419allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9420it.
9421@end defmac
9422
9423@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9424Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9425enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9426assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9427@end defmac
9428
9429@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9430A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9431number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9432@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9433@end defmac
9434
9435@need 2000
9436@node VMS Debug
9437@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9438
9439@c prevent bad page break with this line
9440Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9441
9442@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9443Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9444in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9445is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9446@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9447behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
38f8b050
JR
9448@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9449@end defmac
9450
9451@node Floating Point
9452@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9453@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9454@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9455
9456While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9457there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9458means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9459in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9460doing the compilation.
9461
9462Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9463range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9464the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9465safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9466the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9467emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9468target floating point formats are identical.
9469
9470The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9471use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9472floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9473their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9474
9475@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9476The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9477machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9478array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9479quantity.
9480@end defmac
9481
9482@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9483Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9484floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9485@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9486@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9487@end deftypefn
9488
9489@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9490Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9491@end deftypefn
9492
9493@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9494Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9495@end deftypefn
9496
9497@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9498Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9499@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9500@end deftypefn
9501
9502@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9503Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9504representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9505decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9506defined by the C language for both.
9507@end deftypefn
9508
9509@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9510Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9511@end deftypefn
9512
9513@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9514Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9515@end deftypefn
9516
9517@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9518Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9519@end deftypefn
9520
9521@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9522Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9523@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9524variable).
9525
9526The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9527following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9528@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9529
9530If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9531target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9532@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9533@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9534@end deftypefn
9535
9536@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9537Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9538@end deftypefn
9539
9540@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9541Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9542@end deftypefn
9543
9544@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9545Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9546return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9547appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9548precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9549@end deftypefn
9550
9551@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9552Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9553which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9554integral, it is truncated.
9555@end deftypefn
9556
9557@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9558Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9559into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9560value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9561@end deftypefn
9562
9563@node Mode Switching
9564@section Mode Switching Instructions
9565@cindex mode switching
9566The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9567
9568@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9569Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9570switching in an optimizing compilation.
9571
9572For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9573floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9574the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9575operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9576purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9577be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9578or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9579
9580You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9581which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9582return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9583If you define this macro, you also have to define
9584@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9585@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9586@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9587are optional.
9588@end defmac
9589
9590@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9591If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9592initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9593N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9594of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9595The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9596zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9597entity in question.
9598In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9599represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9600switch is needed / supplied.
9601@end defmac
9602
9603@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9604@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9605@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9606return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9607@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9608be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9609@end defmac
9610
9611@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9612If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9613mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9614different from the incoming mode).
9615@end defmac
9616
9617@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9618If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9619mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9620@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9621is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9622@end defmac
9623
9624@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9625If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9626mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9627@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9628is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9629@end defmac
9630
9631@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9632This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96330 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9634lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9635for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9636(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9637@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9638@end defmac
9639
9640@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9641Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9642@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9643the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9644@end defmac
9645
9646@node Target Attributes
9647@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9648@cindex target attributes
9649@cindex machine attributes
9650@cindex attributes, target-specific
9651
9652Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9653These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9654be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9655
9656@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9657If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9658attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9659specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9660entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9661take.
9662@end deftypevr
9663
9664@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9665If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9666machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9667given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9668subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9669false for all machine-specific attributes.
9670@end deftypefn
9671
9672@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9673If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9674@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9675and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9676generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9677supposed always to be compatible.
9678@end deftypefn
9679
9680@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9681If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9682the newly defined @var{type}.
9683@end deftypefn
9684
9685@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9686Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9687handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9688@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9689that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9690function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9691merging.
9692@end deftypefn
9693
9694@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9695Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9696handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9697@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9698@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9699when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9700attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9701call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9702
9703@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9704If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9705for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9706@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9707will then define a function called
9708@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9709the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9710add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9711to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9712@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9713@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9714@end deftypefn
9715
9716@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9717
9718@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9719Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9720@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9721default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9722@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9723of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9724on this implementation detail.
9725@end defmac
9726
9727@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9728Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9729when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9730wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9731the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9732created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9733for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9734shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9735the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9736attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9737needed.
9738@end deftypefn
9739
9740@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9741@cindex inlining
9742This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9743into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9744attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9745target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9746@end deftypefn
9747
9748@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9749This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9750it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9751options for the current function that might be different than the
9752options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9753@code{true} if the options are valid.
9754
9755The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9756the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9757@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9758@end deftypefn
9759
9760@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9761This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9762in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9763options.
9764@xref{Option file format}.
9765@end deftypefn
9766
9767@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9768This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9769information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9770function specific options.
9771@end deftypefn
9772
9773@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9774This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9775information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9776function specific options.
9777@end deftypefn
9778
56cb42ea 9779@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
38f8b050
JR
9780This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9781set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9782input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9783@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
38f8b050
JR
9784@end deftypefn
9785
9786@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9787Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9788a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9789@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9790once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9791
9792Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9793@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
38f8b050
JR
9794
9795If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9796changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9797@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9798@end deftypefn
9799
9800@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9801This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9802cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9803default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9804specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9805@end deftypefn
9806
9807@node Emulated TLS
9808@section Emulating TLS
9809@cindex Emulated TLS
9810
9811For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9812specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9813used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9814configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9815the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9816layer.
9817
9818The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9819object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9820which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9821address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9822
9823@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9824Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9825object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9826emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9827@end deftypevr
9828
9829@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9830Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9831program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9832initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9833have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9834registration function to be used.
9835@end deftypevr
9836
9837@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9838Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9839be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9840any section.
9841@end deftypevr
9842
9843@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9844Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9845placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9846section.
9847@end deftypevr
9848
9849@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9850Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9851The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9852@end deftypevr
9853
9854@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9855Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9856default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9857@end deftypevr
9858
9859@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9860Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9861object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9862@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9863@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9864for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9865@end deftypefn
9866
9867@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9868Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9869TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9870is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9871initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9872@end deftypefn
9873
9874@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9875Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9876fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9877single objects. The default is false.
9878@end deftypevr
9879
9880@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9881Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9882may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9883@end deftypevr
9884
9885@node MIPS Coprocessors
9886@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9887@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9888
9889The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9890coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9891accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9892and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9893
9894@smallexample
9895 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9896 unsigned int d;
9897
9898 d = cp0count + 3;
9899@end smallexample
9900
9901(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9902names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9903overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9904
9905Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9906be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9907later in the function.
9908
9909Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9910the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9911floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9912
9913There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9914you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9915
9916@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9917A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9918alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9919@smallexample
9920@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9921@end smallexample
9922Default: empty.
9923@end defmac
9924
9925@node PCH Target
9926@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9927@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9928
9929@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9930This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9931@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9932@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9933@end deftypefn
9934
9935@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9936This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9937compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9938if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9939be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9940
9941@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9942when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9943It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9944compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9945
9946The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9947suitable for most targets.
9948@end deftypefn
9949
9950@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9951If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9952@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9953of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9954@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9955value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9956@end deftypefn
9957
9958@node C++ ABI
9959@section C++ ABI parameters
9960@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9961
9962@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9963Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9964These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9965default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9966@end deftypefn
9967
9968@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9969This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9970@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9971@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9972@end deftypefn
9973
9974@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9975This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9976whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9977known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9978@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9979IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9980@end deftypefn
9981
9982@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
9983This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9984array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9985@end deftypefn
9986
9987@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
9988If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9989class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9990will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
9991to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
9992modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
9993backend's targeted operating system.
9994@end deftypefn
9995
9996@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
9997This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
9998the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
9999@code{false}.
10000@end deftypefn
10001
10002@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
10003This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10004which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10005table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10006Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10007the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10008some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10009method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10010@end deftypefn
10011
10012@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
10013
10014@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10015This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10016similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10017external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10018classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10019unit will not be COMDAT.
10020@end deftypefn
10021
10022@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10023This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10024the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10025be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10026@end deftypefn
10027
10028@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10029This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10030should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10031is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10032@end deftypefn
10033
10034@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10035This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10036in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10037destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10038shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10039unloaded. The default is to return false.
10040@end deftypefn
10041
10042@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10043
10044@node Named Address Spaces
10045@section Adding support for named address spaces
10046@cindex named address spaces
10047
10048The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10049standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10050support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10051processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10052GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10053address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10054spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10055@code{const} type attributes.
10056
10057Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10058pointers to the generic address space.
10059
10060For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10061to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10062processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10063issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10064local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10065address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10066@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10067always 32 bits).
10068
10069Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10070range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10071address space.
10072
10073To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10074the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10075the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10076named address space #1:
10077@smallexample
10078#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10079c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10080@end smallexample
10081
10082@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10083Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10084@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10085The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10086generic address space only.
10087@end deftypefn
10088
10089@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10090Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10091@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10092The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10093generic address space only.
10094@end deftypefn
10095
10096@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10097Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10098with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10099hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10100except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10101version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10102@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10103target hooks for the given address space.
10104@end deftypefn
10105
10106@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10107Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10108@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10109parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10110finished. This target hook is the same as the
10111@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10112explicit named address space support.
10113@end deftypefn
10114
10115@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10116Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10117with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10118hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10119except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10120@end deftypefn
10121
10122@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10123Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10124contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10125a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10126will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10127arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10128converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10129@end deftypefn
10130
10131@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10132Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10133@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10134space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10135to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10136guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10137as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10138@end deftypefn
10139
10140@node Misc
10141@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10142@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10143
10144@c prevent bad page break with this line
10145Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10146
10147@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10148Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10149has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10150conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10151blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10152set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10153to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10154@end defmac
10155
10156@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10157Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10158has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10159conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10160blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10161set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10162to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10163@end defmac
10164
10165@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10166An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10167elements of a jump-table should have.
10168@end defmac
10169
10170@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10171Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10172when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10173it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10174To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10175make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10176The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10177flags can be updated.
10178@end defmac
10179
10180@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10181Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10182should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10183jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10184contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10185is in effect.
10186@end defmac
10187
10188@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10189This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10190is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10191The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10192five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10193@end deftypefn
10194
10195@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10196Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10197statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10198advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10199of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10200targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10201@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10202@code{false} otherwise.
10203@end defmac
10204
10205@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10206Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10207smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10208Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10209@end defmac
10210
10211@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10212Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10213memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10214bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10215zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10216of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10217insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10218@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10219
10220This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10221greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10222value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10223@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10224define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10225
10226You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10227the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10228of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10229when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10230integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10231
10232You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10233mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10234@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10235is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10236@end defmac
10237
10238@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10239Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10240extends.
10241@end defmac
10242
10243@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10244Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10245point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10246unsigned one.
10247@end defmac
10248
10249@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10250When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10251divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10252the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10253that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10254of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10255has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10256@end deftypefn
10257
10258@defmac MOVE_MAX
10259The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10260between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10261@end defmac
10262
10263@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10264The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10265between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10266is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10267constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10268at run-time.
10269@end defmac
10270
10271@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10272A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10273actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10274of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10275this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10276a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10277truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10278instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10279include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10280also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10281arguments to bit-field instructions.
10282
10283If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10284position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10285instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10286
10287However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10288only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10289bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10290such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10291the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10292
10293You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10294@end defmac
10295
10296@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10297@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10298This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10299deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10300@xref{shift patterns}.
10301
10302On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10303shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10304equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10305this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10306otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10307particular behavior is guaranteed.
10308
10309Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10310@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10311that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10312
10313The default implementation of this function returns
10314@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10315and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10316@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10317nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10318by overriding it.
10319@end deftypefn
10320
10321@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10322A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10323``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10324bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10325operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10326
10327On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10328
10329@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10330@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10331When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10332modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10333If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10334such cases may improve things.
10335@end defmac
10336
10337@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10338The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10339are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10340@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10341sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10342otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10343representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10344@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10345@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10346@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10347widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10348
10349Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10350value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10351as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10352@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10353
10354Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10355describe two related properties. If you define
10356@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10357to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10358extension.
10359
10360In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10361@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10362@code{mode}.
10363@end deftypefn
10364
10365@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10366A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10367with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10368(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10369apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10370comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10371
10372A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10373comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10374and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10375which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10376true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10377operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10378@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10379@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10380the compiler.
10381
10382If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10383generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10384replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10385the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10386For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10387@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10388@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10389expression
10390
10391@smallexample
10392(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10393@end smallexample
10394
10395@noindent
10396can be converted to
10397
10398@smallexample
10399(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10400@end smallexample
10401
10402@noindent
10403where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10404tested into the sign bit.
10405
10406There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10407for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10408but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10409are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10410perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10411comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10412
10413Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10414from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10415choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10416to be used:
10417
10418@itemize @bullet
10419@item
10420Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10421@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10422``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10423comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10424combine the normalization with other operations.
10425
10426@item
10427For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10428slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10429other machines.
10430
10431@item
10432As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10433exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10434others.
10435
10436@item
10437Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10438@end itemize
10439
10440Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10441@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10442instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10443those cases, e.g., one matching
10444
10445@smallexample
10446(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10447@end smallexample
10448
10449Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10450condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10451@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10452machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10453and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10454@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
2b0d3573 10455@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
38f8b050
JR
10456find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10457
10458If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10459not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10460instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10461@end defmac
10462
10463@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10464A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10465returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10466Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10467floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10468this macro.
10469@end defmac
10470
10471@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10472A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10473for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10474mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10475this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10476return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10477this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10478@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10479the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10480given mode.
10481@end defmac
10482
10483@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10484@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10485A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
ff2ce160 10486for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
38f8b050
JR
10487A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10488If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10489evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10490entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
ff2ce160 10491the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
38f8b050 10492In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
ff2ce160 10493this value.
38f8b050
JR
10494
10495If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10496@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10497
10498This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10499relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10500is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10501to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10502
10503Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10504and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10505visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10506to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10507breaking the API@.
10508@end defmac
10509
10510@defmac Pmode
10511An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10512this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10513pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10514On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10515modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10516
10517The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10518@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10519@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10520to @code{Pmode}.
10521@end defmac
10522
10523@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10524An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10525being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
ff2ce160 10526where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
38f8b050
JR
10527@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10528size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10529as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10530@end defmac
10531
10532@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10533In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10534constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10535hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10536where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10537strict conformance to the C Standard.
10538
10539Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10540convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10541files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10542@end defmac
10543
10544@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10545Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10546This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10547C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10548@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10549@end defmac
10550
10551@findex #pragma
10552@findex pragma
10553@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10554Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10555If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10556@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10557for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10558setup required for the pragmas.
10559
10560The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10561other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10562definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10563
10564If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10565defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10566
10567Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10568@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10569silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10570@end defmac
10571
10572@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10573@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10574
10575Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10576@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10577@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10578pragma of the form
10579
10580@smallexample
10581#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10582@end smallexample
10583
10584@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10585@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10586routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10587on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10588@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10589callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10590a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10591arguments of pragmas registered with
10592@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10593pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10594
10595Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10596compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10597other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10598to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10599building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10600variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10601target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10602the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10603code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10604rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10605how to build this object file.
10606@end deftypefun
10607
38f8b050 10608@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10609Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
38f8b050
JR
10610arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10611@end defmac
10612
10613@hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10614
10615@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10616If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10617the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10618This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10619@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10620@end defmac
10621
10622@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10623Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10624identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10625not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10626there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10627@end defmac
10628
10629@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10630Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10631@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10632G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10633@samp{.} is used instead.
10634@end defmac
10635
10636@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10637Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10638@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10639have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10640are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10641@end defmac
10642
10643@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10644Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10645delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10646even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10647@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10648every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10649or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10650you should define this macro.
10651
10652You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10653@end defmac
10654
10655@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10656Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10657delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10658even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10659@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10660some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10661are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10662define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10663instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10664slot of @var{insn}.
10665
10666You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10667@end defmac
10668
10669@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10670Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10671global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10672symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10673instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10674from shared libraries (DLLs).
10675
10676You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10677@end defmac
10678
10679@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10680This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10681any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10682It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10683clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10684corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10685clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10686@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10687for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10688@end deftypefn
10689
10690@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10691Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10692in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10693@samp{""} if the target does not have a
38f8b050
JR
10694separate math library.
10695
d9d16a19 10696You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
38f8b050
JR
10697@end defmac
10698
10699@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10700Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10701specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10702
10703You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10704is wrong.
10705@end defmac
10706
10707@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10708Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10709functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10710Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10711to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10712if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10713for cross-profiling.
10714@end defmac
10715
10716@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10717
10718A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10719conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10720@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
107211 if it does use cc0.
10722@end defmac
10723
10724@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10725Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10726conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10727@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10728contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10729and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10730then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10731@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10732@end defmac
10733
10734@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10735Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10736if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10737@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10738being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10739@end defmac
10740
10741@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10742A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10743be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10744a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10745about the currently processed blocks.
10746@end defmac
10747
10748@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10749A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10750converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10751can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10752to by @var{ce_info}.
10753@end defmac
10754
10755@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10756A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10757converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10758can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10759to by @var{ce_info}.
10760@end defmac
10761
10762@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10763A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10764structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10765@end defmac
10766
10767@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10768If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10769added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10770by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10771@end defmac
10772
10773@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10774If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10775instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10776just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10777
10778The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10779it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10780laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10781Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10782
10783You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10784definition is null.
10785@end deftypefn
10786
10787@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10788Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10789that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10790necessary setup.
10791
10792Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10793instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10794they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10795instructions or prefetch instructions).
10796
10797To create a built-in function, call the function
10798@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10799which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
1a072294 10800up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
38f8b050
JR
10801only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10802@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10803@end deftypefn
10804
10805@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10806Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10807that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10808builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10809If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10810if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10811If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10812@code{error_mark_node}.
10813@end deftypefn
10814
10815@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10816
10817Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10818@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10819function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10820convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10821@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10822@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10823ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10824built-in function.
10825@end deftypefn
10826
d66f5459 10827@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10828Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10829was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10830@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10831implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10832declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10833arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10834complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10835another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10836@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10837@end deftypefn
10838
08914aaa 10839@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10840Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10841@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10842built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10843the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10844The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10845call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10846@end deftypefn
10847
10848@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10849
10850Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10851low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10852could not be applied.
10853
10854Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10855instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10856the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10857By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10858loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10859@end deftypefn
10860
10861@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10862
10863Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10864Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10865@var{branch2} is possible.
10866
10867On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10868filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10869may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10870@end defmac
10871
10872@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10873This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10874Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10875PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10876of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10877@end deftypefn
10878
10879@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10880
10881When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10882register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10883to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10884it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10885is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10886that had its initial value copied by using
10887@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10888Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10889to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10890the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10891@code{MEM}.
10892If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10893it might decide to use another register anyways.
10894You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10895that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10896register in question will not be clobbered.
10897The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10898allocation.
10899@end deftypefn
10900
10901@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10902This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10903@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10904this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10905@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10906to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10907passed along.
10908@end deftypefn
10909
10910@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
ff2ce160 10911The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
38f8b050
JR
10912context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10913the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10914per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10915attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10916The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10917and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10918and is returning to processing at the top level.
10919The default hook function does nothing.
10920
10921GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10922some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10923situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10924or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10925@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10926outside of any function scope.
10927@end deftypefn
10928
10929@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10930Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10931files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10932use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10933@end defmac
10934
10935@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10936Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10937automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10938do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10939executable files.
10940@end defmac
10941
10942@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10943If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10944specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10945Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10946object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10947lists.
10948@end defmac
10949
10950@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10951Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10952method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10953must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10954For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10955the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10956defined as this expression:
10957
10958@smallexample
10959build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10960 build_tree_list
10961 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10962 NULL))
10963@end smallexample
10964@end defmac
10965
10966@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10967This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10968instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
10969every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
10970reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
10971
10972@smallexample
10973static bool
10974cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
10975@{
10976 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
10977@}
10978@end smallexample
10979@end deftypefn
10980
10981@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
10982This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
10983optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
10984usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
10985re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
10986to inter-block scheduling.
10987@end deftypefn
10988
10989@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
10990Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
10991registers
10992that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
10993returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
10994that all target registers in the class returned by
10995@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
10996saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
10997epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
10998true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
10999to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11000to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11001@end deftypefn
11002
11003@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
11004This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11005This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11006modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11007@end deftypefn
11008
11009@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
11010This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11011should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11012the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11013the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11014is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11015number of memory accesses.
11016@end deftypefn
11017
11018@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11019If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11020that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11021that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11022constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11023more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11024system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11025The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11026@end defmac
11027
11028@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11029This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11030target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11031are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11032The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11033@end deftypefn
11034
11035@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11036This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11037target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11038indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11039@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11040@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11041@end deftypefn
11042
11043@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11044This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11045The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11046systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11047that are different from @option{-I}.
11048@end deftypefn
11049
11050@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11051This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11052for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11053@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11054functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11055@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11056@end defmac
11057
11058@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11059If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11060target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11061option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11062@end defmac
11063
11064@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11065If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11066@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11067@end defmac
11068
11069@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11070If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11071target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11072default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11073@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11074@end defmac
11075
11076@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11077If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11078@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11079@end defmac
11080
11081@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11082If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11083routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11084and scanf formatter settings.
11085@end defmac
11086
11087@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11088If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11089guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11090main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11091important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11092many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11093``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11094and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11095@end deftypevr
11096
11097@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11098If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11099illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11100with prototype @var{typelist}.
11101@end deftypefn
11102
11103@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11104If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11105invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11106if validity should be determined by the front end.
11107@end deftypefn
11108
11109@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11110If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11111invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11112@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11113if validity should be determined by the front end.
11114@end deftypefn
11115
11116@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11117If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11118invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11119and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11120the front end.
11121@end deftypefn
11122
11123@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11124If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11125invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
38f8b050
JR
11126or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11127the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11128@end deftypefn
11129
11130@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11131If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11132invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
38f8b050
JR
11133or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11134the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11135@end deftypefn
11136
11137@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
ff2ce160
MS
11138If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11139@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
38f8b050
JR
11140analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11141front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11142target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11143This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11144@end deftypefn
11145
11146@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
ff2ce160
MS
11147If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11148@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
38f8b050 11149or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
ff2ce160 11150This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
38f8b050
JR
11151conversion rules.
11152This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11153@end deftypefn
11154
11155@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11156This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11157classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11158SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11159@end defmac
11160
11161@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11162This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11163NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11164@end defmac
11165
11166@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11167Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
ff2ce160 11168to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
38f8b050
JR
11169call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11170and the associated definitions of those functions.
11171@end defmac
11172
11173@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11174Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11175necessary.
11176@end deftypefn
11177
11178@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11179This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11180different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11181argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11182is needed.
11183@end deftypefn
11184
11185@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11186When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11187arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11188stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11189debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11190@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11191cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11192to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11193false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11194@end deftypefn
11195
11196@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11197On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11198a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11199is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11200is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11201subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11202the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11203available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11204constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11205down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11206@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11207accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11208value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11209MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11210@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11211is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr